blob: 09f4b669eb1817a668831b5c12d4995f046e90cc [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaud0089302020-04-17 14:19:38 +02007 2020/04/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100604 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100607 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100609 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200610 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200612 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200613 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - presetenv
616 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - uid
618 - ulimit-n
619 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200620 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100621 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-options
627 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200628 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-options
630 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100631 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200632 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100633 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100634 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100635 - 51degrees-data-file
636 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200637 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200638 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-data-file
640 - wurfl-information-list
641 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100643 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100646 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200647 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200649 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100650 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100651 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200653 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200654 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200655 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200656 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - noepoll
658 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000659 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100661 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300662 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000663 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100664 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200665 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200666 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200667 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000668 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000669 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200670 - tune.buffers.limit
671 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200672 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200673 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100674 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200675 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200676 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200677 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100678 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200679 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200680 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100681 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100682 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100683 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100684 - tune.lua.session-timeout
685 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200686 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100687 - tune.maxaccept
688 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200689 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200690 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200691 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100692 - tune.rcvbuf.client
693 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100694 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200695 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100696 - tune.sndbuf.client
697 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100698 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100699 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200700 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100701 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200702 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200703 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100704 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200705 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100706 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200707 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
708 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
709 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100710 - tune.zlib.memlevel
711 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100712
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713 * Debugging
714 - debug
715 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200716 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200717
718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007193.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720------------------------------------
721
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200722ca-base <dir>
723 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100724 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
725 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
726 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200727
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200728chroot <jail dir>
729 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
730 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
731 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
732 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
733 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100734 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100735
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100736cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
737 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
738 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
739 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
740 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
741 set. These sets have the format
742
743 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
744
745 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100746 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100747 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
748 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100749 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
750 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100752 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100753 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100754 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100755 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
756 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
757 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
758 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100759
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100760 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
761 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
762 on the machine's word size.
763
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100764 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100765 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
766 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
767 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
768 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
769 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
770 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771
772 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100773 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
774
775 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
776 # first 4 CPUs
777
778 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
779 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
780 # word size.
781
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100782 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100783 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100784 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
786 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
787
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100788 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
789 # and so on.
790 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
791 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
792 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
793
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100794 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100795 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
796 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
797 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
798
799 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
800 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
801 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
802
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100803 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
804 # and a thread range.
805 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
806 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
808
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200809crt-base <dir>
810 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100811 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
812 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200813
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200814daemon
815 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
816 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100817 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
818 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200820deviceatlas-json-file <path>
821 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100822 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200823
824deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100825 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
827
828deviceatlas-separator <char>
829 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
830 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
831
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100832deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200833 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
834 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
835 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100836
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900837external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100838 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
839 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100840 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
841 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
842 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
843 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
844 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900845
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846gid <number>
847 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
848 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
849 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100850 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
851 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200852 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100853
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100854group <group name>
855 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
856 See also "gid" and "user".
857
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100858hard-stop-after <time>
859 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
860
861 Arguments :
862 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
863 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
864 SIGUSR1 signal.
865
866 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
867 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
868 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
869
870 Example:
871 global
872 hard-stop-after 30s
873
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200874h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
875 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
876 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
877 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
878 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500879 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200880 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
881 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
882 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
883 specified in a proxy.
884
885 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
886 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
887 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
888 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
889 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
890 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
891 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
892
893 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
894 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
895 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
896 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
897 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
898
899 Example:
900 global
901 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
902
903 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
904 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
905
906h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
907 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
908 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
909 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
910 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
911 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
912 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
913 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
914 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
915
916 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
917 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
918 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
919
920 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
921 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
922
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100923insecure-fork-wanted
924 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
925 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
926 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
927 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
928 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
929 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
930 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
931 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
932 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
933 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
934 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
935 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
936 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
937 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
938 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
939 disable it.
940
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100941insecure-setuid-wanted
942 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
943 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
944 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
945 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
946 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
947 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
948 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
949 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
950 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
951 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
952 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
953 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
954 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
955 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
956
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100957issuers-chain-path <dir>
958 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
959 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
960 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
961 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
962 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
963 "issuers-chain-path".
964 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
965 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
966 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
967 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
968 will share the chain in memory.
969
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200970log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
971 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100972 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100973 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100974 configured with "log global".
975
976 <address> can be one of:
977
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100978 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100979 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
980 port).
981
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100982 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
983 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
984 port).
985
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100986 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100987 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
988 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100989 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100990
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100991 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
992 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
993 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
994 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
995 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
996 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
997 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
998 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
999 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1000 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1001 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1002 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1003 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1004 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001005 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1006 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001007
1008 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1009 "fd@2", see above.
1010
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001011 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1012 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1013 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1014 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1015 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1016
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001017 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1018 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001019
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001020 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1021 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1022 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1023 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1024 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1025 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1026 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1027 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1028 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1029 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001030 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1031 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001032
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001033 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1034 one of the following :
1035
1036 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1037 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1038
1039 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1040 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1041
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001042 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1043 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1044 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1045 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1046 logger consumes.
1047
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001048 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1049 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1050 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1051 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1052
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001053 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1054 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1055 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1056 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1057 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1058
1059 <sample_size>
1060 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1061 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1062 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1063 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1064 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1065
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001066 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001067
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001068 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1069 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1070 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1071
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001072 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1073 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1074 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1075 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
1077 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001078 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1079 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1080 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1081 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1082 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1083 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001085 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001086
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001087log-send-hostname [<string>]
1088 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1089 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1090 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1091 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1092 the logs.
1093
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001094log-tag <string>
1095 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1096 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1097 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001098 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001099
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001100lua-load <file>
1101 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1102 used multiple times.
1103
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001104lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1105 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1106 variable.
1107 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1108 to "path".
1109
1110 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1111 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1112 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1113 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1114 will be checked earlier.
1115
1116 As an example by specifying the following path:
1117
1118 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1119 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1120
1121 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1122 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1123 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1124 paths if that does not exist either.
1125
1126 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1127 documentation.
1128
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001129master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001130 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1131 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1132 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001133 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001134 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1135 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001136 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1137 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1138 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1139 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1140 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001141
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001142 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001143
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001144mworker-max-reloads <number>
1145 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001146 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001147 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1148 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1149 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1150
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001151nbproc <number>
1152 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1153 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1154 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001155 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1156 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001157 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1158 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001160nbthread <number>
1161 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001162 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1163 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1164 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1165 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1166 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001167 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1168 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1169 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1170 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1171 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1172 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1173 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001174
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001175pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001176 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1178 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1179
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001180presetenv <name> <value>
1181 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1182 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1183 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1184 and "unsetenv".
1185
1186resetenv [<name> ...]
1187 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1188 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1189 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1190 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1191 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1192 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1193 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1194 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1195
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001196stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001197 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1198 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1199 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1200 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1201 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1202 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001203 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001204 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1205 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1206 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1207 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001208
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001209server-state-base <directory>
1210 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001211 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1212 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001213
1214server-state-file <file>
1215 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1216 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1217 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1218 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1219 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1220 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1221 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1222 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001223 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1224 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001225
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001226setenv <name> <value>
1227 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1228 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1229 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1230 and "unsetenv".
1231
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001232set-dumpable
1233 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001234 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1235 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1236 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1237 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1238 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1239 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1240 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1241 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1242 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1243 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1244 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1245 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1246 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1247 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1248 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1249 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1250 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001251
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001252ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1254 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001255 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001256 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001257 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1258 information and recommendations see e.g.
1259 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1260 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1261 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1262 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001263
1264ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1266 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1267 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1268 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1269 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001270 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1271 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1272 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001273 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001274
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001275ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1277 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1278 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1279 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1280 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1281
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001282ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1284 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1285 keyword to see available options.
1286
1287 Example:
1288 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001289 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001290
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001291ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1293 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001294 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001295 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001296 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1297 information and recommendations see e.g.
1298 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1299 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1300 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1301 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1302 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001303
1304ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1306 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1307 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1308 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1309 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001310 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1311 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1312 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1313 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001314
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001315ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1317 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1318 keyword to see available options.
1319
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001320ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1322 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1323 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001324 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001325 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001326 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1327 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1328 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1329 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001330 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1331 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1332 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1333
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001334ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001335 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1336 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1337
1338 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1339 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1340 optimize the startup time.
1341
1342 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1343 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1344 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1345
1346 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001347 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001348
1349 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1350 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1351 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1352 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1353 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1354 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001355 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001356 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1357
1358 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1359
1360 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1361
1362 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1363 not provided in the PEM file.
1364
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001365 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1366 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1367
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001368 The default behavior is "all".
1369
1370 Example:
1371 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1372 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1373 ssl-load-extra-files none
1374
1375 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1376
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001377ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1378 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1379 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1380 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1381
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001382ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1383 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1384 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1385 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1386 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1387 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1388 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1389 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1390 bits does not need it.
1391
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001392stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1393 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1394 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1395 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001396 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001397 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001398
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001399 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1400 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1401 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001402
1403stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1404 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1405 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001406 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001407
1408stats maxconn <connections>
1409 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1410 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1411
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001412uid <number>
1413 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1414 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1415 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1416 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1417
1418ulimit-n <number>
1419 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1420 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1421 option.
1422
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001423unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1424 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1425
1426 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1427 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1428 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1429 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1430 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1431 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1432 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1433 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1434 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1435 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1436
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001437unsetenv [<name> ...]
1438 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1439 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1440 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1441 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1442 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1443 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1444 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1445
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001446user <user name>
1447 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1448 See also "uid" and "group".
1449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001450node <name>
1451 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1452
1453 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1454 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1455 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1456 traffic.
1457
1458description <text>
1459 Add a text that describes the instance.
1460
1461 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1462 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1463 "<" and ">" characters.
1464
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100146551degrees-data-file <file path>
1466 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001467 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001468
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001469 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001470 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1471
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000147251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001473 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1474 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1475 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1476
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001477 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001478 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1479
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200148051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001481 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1482 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1483
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001484 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1485 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1486
148751degrees-cache-size <number>
1488 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1489 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1490 By default, this cache is disabled.
1491
1492 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001493 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1494
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001495wurfl-data-file <file path>
1496 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1497 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1498
1499 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1500 with USE_WURFL=1.
1501
1502wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1503 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1504 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1505 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1506
1507 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1508
1509 Valid WURFL properties are:
1510 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1511
1512 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1513 device.
1514
1515 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1516 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1517
1518 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1519 particular web request.
1520
1521 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1522 used Libwurfl API version.
1523
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001524 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1525 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1526
1527 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1528 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1529
1530 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1531
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001532 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1533 with USE_WURFL=1.
1534
1535wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1536 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1537 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1538
1539 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1540 with USE_WURFL=1.
1541
1542wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1543 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1544 thus before the chroot.
1545
1546 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1547 with USE_WURFL=1.
1548
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001549wurfl-cache-size <size>
1550 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1551 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001552 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001553 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001554
1555 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1556 with USE_WURFL=1.
1557
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001558strict-limits
1559 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1560 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1561 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1562 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1563 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1564 keyword.
1565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015663.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001567-----------------------
1568
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001569busy-polling
1570 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1571 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1572 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1573 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1574 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1575 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1576 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1577 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1578 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1579 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1580 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1581 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1582 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1583 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1584 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1585 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1586 "poll" pollers.
1587
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001588 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1589 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1590 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1591
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001592max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1593 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1594 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1595 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1596 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1597 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1598 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1599 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1600 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1601
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001602maxconn <number>
1603 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1604 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1605 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001606 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1607 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1608 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1609 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001610 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1611 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1612 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1613 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1614 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1615 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001616
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001617maxconnrate <number>
1618 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1619 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1620 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1621 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1622 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1623 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1624 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1625 fairness.
1626
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001627maxcomprate <number>
1628 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001629 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001630 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1631 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1632 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001633 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001634 default value.
1635
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001636maxcompcpuusage <number>
1637 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1638 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1639 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1640 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1641 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1642 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1643 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1644 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1645
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001646maxpipes <number>
1647 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1648 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1649 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1650 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1651 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1652 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1653
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001654maxsessrate <number>
1655 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1656 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1657 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1658 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1659 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1660 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1661 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1662 fairness.
1663
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001664maxsslconn <number>
1665 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1666 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1667 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1668 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1669 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1670 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1671 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001672 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1673 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1674 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1675 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1676 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1677 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1678 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001679
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001680maxsslrate <number>
1681 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1682 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1683 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1684 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1685 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1686 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1687 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1688 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1689 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1690 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1691
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001692maxzlibmem <number>
1693 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1694 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1695 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001696 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1697 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1698 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001700noepoll
1701 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1702 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001703 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001704
1705nokqueue
1706 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1707 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1708 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1709
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001710noevports
1711 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1712 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1713 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1714 also "nopoll".
1715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001716nopoll
1717 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1718 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001720 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1721 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001722
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001723nosplice
1724 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001725 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001726 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001727 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001728 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1729 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1730 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1731 "option splice-response".
1732
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001733nogetaddrinfo
1734 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1735 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1736
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001737noreuseport
1738 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1739 command line argument "-dR".
1740
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001741profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1742 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1743 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1744 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1745 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001746 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001747 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1748 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1749 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1750 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1751
1752 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1753 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1754 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1755 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1756 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001757 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1758 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1759 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1760 CLI.
1761
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001762spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001763 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1764 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1765 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1766 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1767 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1768 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001770ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001771 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001772 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001773 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1774 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1775 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1776 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1777 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001778 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1779 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001780 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1781 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1782 openssl configuration file uses:
1783 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1784
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001785ssl-mode-async
1786 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001787 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001788 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1789 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1790 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001791 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001792 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001793
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001794tune.buffers.limit <number>
1795 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1796 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1797 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1798 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1799 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001800 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001801 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1802 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1803 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1804 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1805 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1806 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1807 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1808 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1809 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1810
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001811tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1812 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1813 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1814 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1815 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1816
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001817tune.bufsize <number>
1818 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1819 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1820 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1821 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1822 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1823 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1824 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001825 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1826 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1827 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001828 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001829 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1830 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1831 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001832
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001833tune.chksize <number>
1834 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1835 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1836 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1837 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1838 checks whenever possible.
1839
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001840tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1841 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1842 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1843 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1844 this value. The default value is 1.
1845
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001846tune.fail-alloc
1847 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1848 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1849 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1850 gracefully.
1851
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001852tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1853 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1854 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1855 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1856 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1857 change it.
1858
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001859tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1860 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001861 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1862 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001863 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1864 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1865 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1866 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1867 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1868
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001869tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1870 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1871 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1872 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1873 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1874 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1875 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1876 recommended not to change this value.
1877
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001878tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1879 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1880 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1881 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1882 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1883 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1884 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1885 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1886
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001887tune.http.cookielen <number>
1888 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1889 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1890 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1891 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1892 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1893 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1894 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1895 to change this value.
1896
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001897tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001898 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1899 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001900 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001901 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001902 configuration directives too.
1903 The default value is 1024.
1904
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001905tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1906 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1907 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1908 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1909 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1910 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1911 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001912 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1913 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1914 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001915
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001916tune.idletimer <timeout>
1917 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1918 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1919 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1920 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1921 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1922 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001923 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001924 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001925 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1926
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001927tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1928 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1929 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1930 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1931 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1932 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1933 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1934 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1935 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1936 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1937
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001938tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1939 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001940 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001941 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1942 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001943 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001944 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1945 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1946
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001947tune.lua.maxmem
1948 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1949 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1950 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1951 memory.
1952
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001953tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1954 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001955 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1956 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001957 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001958
1959tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1960 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1961 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1962 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1963 check servers.
1964
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001965tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1966 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1967 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1968 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001969 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001970
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001971tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001972 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1973 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1974 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1975 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1976 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1977 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1978 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1979 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1980 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1981 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001982
1983tune.maxpollevents <number>
1984 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1985 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1986 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1987 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1988 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1989
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001990tune.maxrewrite <number>
1991 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1992 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1993 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1994 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1995 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1996 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1997 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1998 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1999 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2000 bufsize.
2001
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002002tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2003 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2004 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2005 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2006 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2007 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2008 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2009 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2010 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2011 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002012 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2013 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002014 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2015 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2016 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2017 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2018 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2019 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2020 setting this parameter to 0.
2021
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002022tune.pipesize <number>
2023 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2024 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2025 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2026 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2027 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2028 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2029
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002030tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2031 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2032 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2033 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2034 default is 20.
2035
2036tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2037 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2038 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2039 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2040 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2041 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2042 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002043 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002044
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002045tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2046tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2047 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2048 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2049 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002050 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002051 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002052 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2053 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2054
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002055tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002056 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002057 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2058 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2059 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2060 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2061
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002062tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002063 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002064 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2065 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2066
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002067tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2068tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2069 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2070 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2071 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002072 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002073 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002074 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2075 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2076 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2077 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2078 notifying haproxy again.
2079
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002080tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002081 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2082 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2083 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002084 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002085 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002086 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002087 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2088 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2089 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002090 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2091 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002092
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002093tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002094 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002095 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2096 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2097 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2098 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2099 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2100
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002101tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2102 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002103 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002104 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2105 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2106 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2107 being used for too long.
2108
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002109tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2110 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2111 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2112 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2113 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2114 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2115 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2116 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2117 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2118 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2119 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002120 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002121 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002122
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002123tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2124 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2125 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2126 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2127 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2128 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2129 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2130 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002131 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2132 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002133
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002134tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2135 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2136 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2137 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2138 1000 entries.
2139
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002140tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2141 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2142 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2143 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2144
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002145tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002146tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002147tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2148tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2149tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002150 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2151 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2152 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2153 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2154 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2155 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2156 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2157 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002158
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002159 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2160 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2161 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2162 all available space is consumed.
2163 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2164 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2165 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002166
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002167tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2168 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002169 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002170 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002171 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002172 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2173
2174tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2175 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2176 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002177 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2178 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021803.3. Debugging
2181--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002182
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002183debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002184 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2185 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2186 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2187 system startup.
2188
2189quiet
2190 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2191 line argument "-q".
2192
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002193zero-warning
2194 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2195 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2196 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2197 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2198 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2199 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2200
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002201
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022023.4. Userlists
2203--------------
2204It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2205http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2206it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2207
2208userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002209 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002210 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2211
2212group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002213 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002214 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2215 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2216
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002217user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2218 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002219 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2220 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002221 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2222 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2223 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2224 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002225
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002226 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2227 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2228 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2229 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2230 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2231 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2232 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2233 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2234 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002235
2236 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002237 userlist L1
2238 group G1 users tiger,scott
2239 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002240
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002241 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2242 user scott insecure-password elgato
2243 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002244
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002245 userlist L2
2246 group G1
2247 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002248
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002249 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2250 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2251 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002252
2253 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002254
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002255
22563.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002257----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002258It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2259several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2260instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2261values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2262automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2263In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2264using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2265tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2266reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2267Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2268that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2269each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002270
2271peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002272 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002273 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2274
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002275bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2276 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2277 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2278
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002279disabled
2280 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2281 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2282 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2283
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002284default-bind [param*]
2285 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2286
2287default-server [param*]
2288 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2289
2290 Arguments:
2291 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2292 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2293 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2294 details.
2295
2296
2297 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2298
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002299enable
2300 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2301
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002302log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2303 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2304 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2305 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2306 more details.
2307
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002308peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002309 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2310 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2311 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2312 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2313 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2314 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2315
2316 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2317 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2318
2319 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2320 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2321 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2322 across all peers.
2323
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002324 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2325 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002326
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002327 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2328 "server" keyword explanation below).
2329
2330server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002331 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002332 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2333 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2334 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2335 of this "peers" section).
2336 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2337
2338
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002339 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002340 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002341 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002342 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2343 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2344 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002345
2346 backend mybackend
2347 mode tcp
2348 balance roundrobin
2349 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2350 stick on src
2351
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002352 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2353 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002354
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002355 Example:
2356 peers mypeers
2357 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2358 default-server ssl verify none
2359 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2360 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002361
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002362
2363table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2364 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2365
2366 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2367 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002368 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002369 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2370 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2371 "stick-table" keyword).
2372
2373 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2374 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2375 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2376 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2377 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2378 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2379 of the stick-table name as follows:
2380
2381 peers mypeers
2382 peer A ...
2383 peer B ...
2384 table t1 ...
2385
2386 frontend fe1
2387 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2388
2389 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2390 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2391
2392 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2393 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2394 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2395 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2396 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2397 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2398 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2399
2400 peers mypeers
2401 peer A ...
2402 peer B ...
2403 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2404
2405 backend t1
2406 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2407
2408 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2409 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2410 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2411
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024123.6. Mailers
2413------------
2414It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2415If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2416in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2417
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002418mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002419 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2420 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2421
2422mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2423 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2424
2425 Example:
2426 mailers mymailers
2427 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2428 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2429
2430 backend mybackend
2431 mode tcp
2432 balance roundrobin
2433
2434 email-alert mailers mymailers
2435 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2436 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2437
2438 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2439 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2440
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002441timeout mail <time>
2442 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2443 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2444 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2445 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2446
2447 Example:
2448 mailers mymailers
2449 timeout mail 20s
2450 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002451
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024523.7. Programs
2453-------------
2454In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2455master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2456managed the same way as the workers.
2457
2458During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2459sequence as a worker:
2460
2461 - the master is re-executed
2462 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2463 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2464 instance of the program
2465
2466During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2467
2468program <name>
2469 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2470 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2471 the management guide).
2472
2473command <command> [arguments*]
2474 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2475 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2476 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2477 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2478
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002479user <user name>
2480 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2481 See also "group".
2482
2483group <group name>
2484 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2485 See also "user".
2486
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002487option start-on-reload
2488no option start-on-reload
2489 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2490 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2491 program section.
2492
2493
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024943.8. HTTP-errors
2495----------------
2496
2497It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2498imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2499several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2500
2501http-errors <name>
2502 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2503 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2504
2505errorfile <code> <file>
2506 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2507
2508 Arguments :
2509 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2510 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2511 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2512
2513 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2514 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2515 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2516 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2517 before any chroot is performed.
2518
2519 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2520
2521 Example:
2522 http-errors website-1
2523 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2524 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2525 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2526
2527 http-errors website-2
2528 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2529 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2530 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2531
2532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025334. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002534----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002536Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002537 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002538 - frontend <name>
2539 - backend <name>
2540 - listen <name>
2541
2542A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2543its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2544section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002545section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002546
2547A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2548connections.
2549
2550A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2551to forward incoming connections.
2552
2553A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2554parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002556All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2557'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2558case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2559
2560Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2561logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2562proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2563However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2564name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2565
2566Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2567and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002568bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2570modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2571arbitrary criteria.
2572
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002573In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2574a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002575the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002576
2577 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2578 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2579 between responses and new requests.
2580
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002581 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2582 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2583 client-facing connection remains open.
2584
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002585 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2586 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002587
2588The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2589frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2590following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002591weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002592
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002593 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002594
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002595 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2596 ----+-----+-----+----
2597 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2598 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002599 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2600 ----+-----+-----+----
2601 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002602
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026054.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2606--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002608The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2609limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2610they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2611limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002612marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002613option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002614and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2615with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2616specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002617
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002618
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002619 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2620------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2621acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002622backlog X X X -
2623balance X - X X
2624bind - X X -
2625bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002626capture cookie - X X -
2627capture request header - X X -
2628capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002629compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002630cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002631declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002632default-server X - X X
2633default_backend X X X -
2634description - X X X
2635disabled X X X X
2636dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002637email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002638email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002639email-alert mailers X X X X
2640email-alert myhostname X X X X
2641email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002642enabled X X X X
2643errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002644errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002645errorloc X X X X
2646errorloc302 X X X X
2647-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2648errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002649force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002650filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002651fullconn X - X X
2652grace X X X X
2653hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002654http-after-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002655http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002656http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002657http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002658http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002659http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002660http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002661http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002662id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002663ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002664load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002665log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002666log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002667log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002668log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002669max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002670maxconn X X X -
2671mode X X X X
2672monitor fail - X X -
2673monitor-net X X X -
2674monitor-uri X X X -
2675option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2676option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2677option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2678option allbackups (*) X - X X
2679option checkcache (*) X - X X
2680option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2681option contstats (*) X X X -
2682option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2683option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002684-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2685option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002686option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2687option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002688option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002689option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002690option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002691option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002692option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002693option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2694option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2695option httpchk X - X X
2696option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002697option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002698option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002699option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002700option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002701option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002702option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2703option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2704option logasap (*) X X X -
2705option mysql-check X - X X
2706option nolinger (*) X X X X
2707option originalto X X X X
2708option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002709option pgsql-check X - X X
2710option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002711option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002712option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002713option smtpchk X - X X
2714option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2715option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2716option splice-request (*) X X X X
2717option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002718option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002719option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2720option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2721-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002722option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002723option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2724option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2725option tcpka X X X X
2726option tcplog X X X X
2727option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002728external-check command X - X X
2729external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002730persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2731rate-limit sessions X X X -
2732redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002733-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002734retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002735retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002736server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002737server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002738server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002739source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002740stats admin - X X X
2741stats auth X X X X
2742stats enable X X X X
2743stats hide-version X X X X
2744stats http-request - X X X
2745stats realm X X X X
2746stats refresh X X X X
2747stats scope X X X X
2748stats show-desc X X X X
2749stats show-legends X X X X
2750stats show-node X X X X
2751stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002752-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2753stick match - - X X
2754stick on - - X X
2755stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002756stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002757stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002758tcp-check connect - - X X
2759tcp-check expect - - X X
2760tcp-check send - - X X
2761tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002762tcp-request connection - X X -
2763tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002764tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002765tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002766tcp-response content - - X X
2767tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002768timeout check X - X X
2769timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002770timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002771timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002772timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2773timeout http-request X X X X
2774timeout queue X - X X
2775timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002776timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002777timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002778timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002779transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002780unique-id-format X X X -
2781unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002782use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002783use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002784use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002785------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2786 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002787
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027894.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2790---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002791
2792This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2793
2794
2795acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2796 Declare or complete an access list.
2797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2798 no | yes | yes | yes
2799 Example:
2800 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2801 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2802 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2803
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002804 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002805
2806
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002807backlog <conns>
2808 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2810 yes | yes | yes | no
2811 Arguments :
2812 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2813 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002814 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002815
2816 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2817 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2818 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2819 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2820 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2821 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2822 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2823 backlog parameter.
2824
2825 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2826 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2827 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2828
2829 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2830
2831
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002832balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002833balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002834 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2836 yes | no | yes | yes
2837 Arguments :
2838 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2839 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2840 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2841 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2842
2843 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2844 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2845 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2846 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002847 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002848 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002849 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2850 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2851 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2852 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2853 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2854 it, so that you don't worry.
2855
2856 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2857 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2858 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2859 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2860 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2861 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2862 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2863 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002865 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2866 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2867 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2868 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2869 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2870 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2871 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2872 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2873
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002874 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002875 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002876 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2877 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002878 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002879 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2880 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2881 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2882 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2883 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002884 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2885 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2886 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2887 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2888 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2889 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002890
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2892 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2893 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2894 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2895 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2896 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2897 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2898 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002899 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002900 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002901 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2902 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2903 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002904
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002905 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2906 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2907 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2908 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2909 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2910 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2911 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2912 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2913 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2914 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2915 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2916 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002918 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002919 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2920 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2921 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2922 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2923 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2924 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2925 URIs start with a leading "/".
2926
2927 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2928 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2929 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2930 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2931
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002932 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002933 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2934
2935 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002936 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2937 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002938 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2939 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2940 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2941 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002942 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002943 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2944 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002945
2946 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2947 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2948 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2949 server will receive the request.
2950
2951 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2952 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2953 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2954 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2955 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002956 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2957 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2958 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002959
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002960 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2961 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2962 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2963 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2964 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002965
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002966 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002967 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2968 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2969 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2970
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002971 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2972 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2973 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2974
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002975 random
2976 random(<draws>)
2977 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002978 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2979 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2980 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2981 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002982 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2983 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2984 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2985 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2986 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2987 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2988 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2989 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2990 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2991 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2992 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2993 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2994 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2995 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2996 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2997 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2998 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2999 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3000 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3001 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003002
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003003 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003004 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003005 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3006 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3007 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3008 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3009 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3010 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003011 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003012 used instead.
3013
3014 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3015 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3016 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3017 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3018
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003019 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3020 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3021 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3022
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003023 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003024
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003025 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003026 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3027 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003028
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003029 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3030 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3031 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003032
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003033 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003034 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003035 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3036 NTLM relies on.
3037
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003038 Examples :
3039 balance roundrobin
3040 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003041 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003042 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3043 balance hdr(host)
3044 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003045
3046 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3047 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003049 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003050 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3051 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3052 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003053 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003054
3055 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3056 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3057 defaults to 16 kB.
3058
3059 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3060 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3061
3062 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3063 Round Robin.
3064
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003065 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003066 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3067 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3068 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3069
3070 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3071
3072 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003073 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003074 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3075 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3076 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003077
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003078 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003079
3080
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003081bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3082bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3085 no | yes | yes | no
3086 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003087 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3088 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3089 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3090 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003091 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003092 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3093 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3094 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3095 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3096 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3097 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3098 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003099 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3100 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3101 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3102 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3103 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3104 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3105 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003106 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3107 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3108 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003109 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3110 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3111 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3112 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003113 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3114 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3115 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003116
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003117 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3118 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003119 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3120 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3121 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003122 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3123 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3124 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3125 the range.
3126
3127 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3128 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3129 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3130 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3131 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3132 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3133 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003134 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003135 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003136
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003137 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003138 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003139 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3140 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3141 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3142 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3143 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3144 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3145
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003146 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3147 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3148 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3149 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003150
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3152 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3153 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3154 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3155 in a frontend.
3156
3157 Example :
3158 listen http_proxy
3159 bind :80,:443
3160 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003161 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003163 listen http_https_proxy
3164 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003165 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003166
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003167 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3168 bind ipv6@:80
3169 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3170 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3171
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003172 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003173 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003174
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003175 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3176 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3177 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3178 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3179 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3180
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003181 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003182 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183
3184
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003185bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003186 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3188 yes | yes | yes | yes
3189 Arguments :
3190 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3191 may be used to override a default value.
3192
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003193 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003194 option may be combined with other numbers.
3195
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003196 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003197 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3198 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3199 missing from all processes.
3200
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003201 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003202 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003203 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3204 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3205 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3206 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3207 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003208 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003209
3210 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3211 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3212 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3213 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3214 and 'even' instances.
3215
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003216 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3217 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3218 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3219 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003220
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003221 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3222 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3223
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003224 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3225 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3226 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3227
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003228 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3229 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3230
3231 Example :
3232 listen app_ip1
3233 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003234 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003235
3236 listen app_ip2
3237 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003238 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003239
3240 listen management
3241 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003242 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003243
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003244 listen management
3245 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3246 bind-process 1-4
3247
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003248 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003249
3250
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003251capture cookie <name> len <length>
3252 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3254 no | yes | yes | no
3255 Arguments :
3256 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3257 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3258 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3259 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003260 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003261
3262 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3263 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3264 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3265 right if it exceeds <length>.
3266
3267 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3268 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3269 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3270 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3271
3272 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3273 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3274 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3275
3276 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3277 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3278 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003279 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3280 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3281 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003282
3283 Example:
3284 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3285
3286 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003287 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003288
3289
3290capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003291 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3293 no | yes | yes | no
3294 Arguments :
3295 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003296 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003297 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3298 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3299 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3300
3301 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3302 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3303 it exceeds <length>.
3304
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003305 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3307 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003308 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3309 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3310 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3311 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003312 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003313 environments to find where the request came from.
3314
3315 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3316 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3317 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3318 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003319
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003320 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3321 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3322 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3323 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3324 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003325
3326 Example:
3327 capture request header Host len 15
3328 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003329 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003331 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003332 about logging.
3333
3334
3335capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003336 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3338 no | yes | yes | no
3339 Arguments :
3340 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003341 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003342 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3343 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3344 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3345
3346 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3347 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3348 it exceeds <length>.
3349
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003350 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003351 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3352 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3353 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003354 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3355 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3356 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3357 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003359 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3360 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3361 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3362 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3363 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003364
3365 Example:
3366 capture response header Content-length len 9
3367 capture response header Location len 15
3368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003369 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003370 about logging.
3371
3372
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003373compression algo <algorithm> ...
3374compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003375compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003376 Enable HTTP compression.
3377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3378 yes | yes | yes | yes
3379 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003380 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3381 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3382 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3383
3384 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003385 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3386 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3387 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003388
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003389 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003390 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003391
3392 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3393 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3394 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3395 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3396 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003397 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003398
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003399 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3400 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3401 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3402 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3403 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3404 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3405 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003406 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003407
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003408 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003409 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003410 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3411 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3412 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3413 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3414 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003415
3416 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3417 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3418 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3419 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3420 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003421 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3422 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3423 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3424 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3425 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003426 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3427 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003428
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003429 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003430 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3431 "Accept-Encoding" header
3432 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003433 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003434 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3435 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3436 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3437 "multipart"
3438 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3439 header
3440 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3441 and later
3442 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3443 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003444 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003445
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003446 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003447
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003448 Examples :
3449 compression algo gzip
3450 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003451
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003452
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003453cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003454 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3455 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003456 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003457 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3459 yes | no | yes | yes
3460 Arguments :
3461 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3462 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3463 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3464 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3465 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3466 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003467 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003468 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3469 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3470
3471 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3472 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3473 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3474 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3475 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3476 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003477 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3478 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003479 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003480 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3481 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003482
3483 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003484 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003485
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003486 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003487 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003488 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003489 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003490 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3491 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3492 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3493 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3494 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3495 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3496 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003497
3498 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3499 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3500 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3501 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3502 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3503 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3504 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3505 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3506 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003507 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003508 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3509 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3510 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003511
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003512 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3513 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3514 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003515 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3516 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3517 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3518 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003519 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3520 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3521 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003522
3523 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3524 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3525 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3526 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3527 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3528 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3529 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3530 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3531 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3532
3533 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3534 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3535 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3536 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3537 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3538 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3539 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3540 persistence cookie in the cache.
3541 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3542
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003543 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3544 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3545 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3546 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3547 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003548 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003549 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3550 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3551 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3552 they logout.
3553
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003554 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3555 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3556 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3557 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3558
3559 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3560 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3561 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3562 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3563 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3564 this attribute.
3565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003566 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003567 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003568 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3569 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3570 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3571 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3572 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3573 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003574
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003575 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3576 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3577 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3578 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3579 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3580 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3581 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3582 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003583 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003584 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3585 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3586 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3587 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3588 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3589 the site.
3590
3591 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3592 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3593 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3594 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3595 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3596 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3597 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3598 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3599 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3600 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3601 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3602 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3603 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003604 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003605 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3606 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3607
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003608 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3609 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3610 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3611 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3612 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3613 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3614
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003615 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3616 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3617 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3618 repeated.
3619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003620 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3621 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3622 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3623 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003624
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003625 Examples :
3626 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3627 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3628 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003629 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003630
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003631 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003632
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003633
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003634declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3635 Declares a capture slot.
3636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3637 no | yes | yes | no
3638 Arguments:
3639 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3640
3641 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3642 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3643 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3644 for use in the response.
3645
3646 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003647 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003648 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3649
3650
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003651default-server [param*]
3652 Change default options for a server in a backend
3653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3654 yes | no | yes | yes
3655 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003656 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3657 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3658 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3659 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003660
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003661 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003662 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3663
3664 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003665
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003666
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003667default_backend <backend>
3668 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3670 yes | yes | yes | no
3671 Arguments :
3672 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3673
3674 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3675 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3676 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3677 will catch all undetermined requests.
3678
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003679 Example :
3680
3681 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3682 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3683 default_backend dynamic
3684
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003685 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003687
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003688description <string>
3689 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3691 no | yes | yes | yes
3692 Arguments : string
3693
3694 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3695 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3696 it describes.
3697 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3698
3699
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003700disabled
3701 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3703 yes | yes | yes | yes
3704 Arguments : none
3705
3706 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3707 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3708 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3709 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3710 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3711 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3712 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3713
3714 See also : "enabled"
3715
3716
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003717dispatch <address>:<port>
3718 Set a default server address
3719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3720 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003721 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003722
3723 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3724 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3725 during start-up.
3726
3727 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3728 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3729 possible with normal servers.
3730
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003731 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003732 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3733 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3734 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3735 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3736
3737 See also : "server"
3738
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003739
3740dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3741 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3743 yes | no | yes | yes
3744 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3745
3746 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003747 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003748 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3749 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003750 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003751 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003752
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003753enabled
3754 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3756 yes | yes | yes | yes
3757 Arguments : none
3758
3759 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3760 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3761
3762 See also : "disabled"
3763
3764
3765errorfile <code> <file>
3766 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3768 yes | yes | yes | yes
3769 Arguments :
3770 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003771 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3772 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003773
3774 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003775 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003776 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003777 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3778 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003779
3780 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3781 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3782 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3783
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003784 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3785
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003786 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3787 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3788 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3789 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3790
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003791 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3792 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003793 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003794 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3795 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3796 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3797
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003798 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3799 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3800 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003801 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003802 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3803
3804 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3805
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003806 Example :
3807 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003808 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003809 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3810 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3811
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003812
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003813errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3814 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3815 section.
3816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3817 yes | yes | yes | yes
3818 Arguments :
3819 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3820
3821 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3822 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3823 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3824
3825 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3826 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3827 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3828 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3829 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3830 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3831 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3832
3833 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3834 3.8 about http-errors.
3835
3836 Example :
3837 errorfiles generic
3838 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3839
3840
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003841errorloc <code> <url>
3842errorloc302 <code> <url>
3843 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3845 yes | yes | yes | yes
3846 Arguments :
3847 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003848 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3849 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003850
3851 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3852 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3853 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3854 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003855 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003856
3857 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3858 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3859 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3860
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003861 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3862
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003863 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3864 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3865 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3866 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003867 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003868 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3869 request.
3870
3871 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3872
3873
3874errorloc303 <code> <url>
3875 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3877 yes | yes | yes | yes
3878 Arguments :
3879 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003880 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3881 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003882
3883 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3884 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3885 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3886 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003887 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003888
3889 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3890 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3891 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3892
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003893 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3894
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003895 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3896 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3897 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3898 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003899 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003900
3901 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3902
3903
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003904email-alert from <emailaddr>
3905 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003906 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003907 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3908 yes | yes | yes | yes
3909
3910 Arguments :
3911
3912 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3913
3914 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3915 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3916
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003917 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003918 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3919 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003920
3921
3922email-alert level <level>
3923 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3924 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3925 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3926 yes | yes | yes | yes
3927
3928 Arguments :
3929
3930 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3931 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3932 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3933
3934 By default level is alert
3935
3936 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3937 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3938 for the proxy.
3939
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003940 Alerts are sent when :
3941
3942 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3943 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3944 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3945 is notice or lower
3946 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3947 and a health check status update occurs
3948
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003949 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3950 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003951 section 3.6 about mailers.
3952
3953
3954email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3955 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3956 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3957 yes | yes | yes | yes
3958
3959 Arguments :
3960
3961 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3962
3963 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3964 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3965
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003966 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3967 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003968
3969
3970email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3971 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3972 mailers.
3973 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3974 yes | yes | yes | yes
3975
3976 Arguments :
3977
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003978 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003979
3980 By default the systems hostname is used.
3981
3982 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3983 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3984 for the proxy.
3985
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003986 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3987 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003988
3989
3990email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003991 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003992 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3994 yes | yes | yes | yes
3995
3996 Arguments :
3997
3998 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3999
4000 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4001 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4002
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004003 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004004 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4005
4006
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004007force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4008 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4009 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004010 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004011
4012 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4013 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4014 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4015 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4016 marked down for maintenance operations.
4017
4018 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4019 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4020 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4021 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4022 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4023 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4024 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4025 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4026 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4027
4028 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4029 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4030 is used.
4031
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004032 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004033 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004034
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004035
4036filter <name> [param*]
4037 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4039 no | yes | yes | yes
4040 Arguments :
4041 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4042 referenced in section 9.
4043
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004044 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004045 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004046 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4047 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004048
4049 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4050 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4051
4052 Example:
4053 listen
4054 bind *:80
4055
4056 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4057 filter compression
4058 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4059
4060 compression algo gzip
4061 compression offload
4062
4063 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4064
4065 See also : section 9.
4066
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004067
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004068fullconn <conns>
4069 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4071 yes | no | yes | yes
4072 Arguments :
4073 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4074 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4075
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004076 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004077 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004078 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004079 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4080 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4081 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4082 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4083 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004084 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004085
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004086 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4087 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004088 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4089 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4090 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004091
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004092 Example :
4093 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4094 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4095 # connections.
4096 backend dynamic
4097 fullconn 10000
4098 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4099 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4100
4101 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4102
4103
4104grace <time>
4105 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004107 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004108 Arguments :
4109 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4110 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4111 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4112
4113 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4114 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004115 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004116 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4117
4118 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4119 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4120 simplify it.
4121
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004122
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004123hash-balance-factor <factor>
4124 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4126 yes | no | no | yes
4127 Arguments :
4128 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4129 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004130 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004131
4132 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4133 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4134 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4135 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4136 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4137 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4138 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4139
4140 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4141 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4142 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4143 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4144 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4145
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004146 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4147 consistent hashing mechanism.
4148
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004149 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4150
4151
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004152hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004153 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4155 yes | no | yes | yes
4156 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004157 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4158 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004159
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004160 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4161 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4162 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4163 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4164 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4165 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4166 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4167 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4168 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4169 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004170
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004171 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4172 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4173 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4174 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4175 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4176 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4177 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4178 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4179 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4180 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4181 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4182 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4183 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004184 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4185 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004186
4187 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4188
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004189 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004190 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4191 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4192 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004193 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4194 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4195 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004196
4197 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4198 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004199 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4200 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4201 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4202 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4203
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004204 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4205 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4206 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4207 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4208 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4209 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4210 parameter.
4211
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004212 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4213 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4214 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4215 used on strings.
4216
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004217 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4218
4219 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4220 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4221 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4222 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4223 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4224 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4225 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4226 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4227 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4228 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4229 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4230 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004231
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004232 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4233 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4234 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004235
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004236 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004237
4238
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004239http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4240 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4241 ones).
4242
4243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4244 no | yes | yes | yes
4245
4246 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4247 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4248 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4249 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4250 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4251 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4252
4253 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4254 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4255 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4256
4257 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4258 below.
4259
4260 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4261 instance.
4262
4263 Example:
4264 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4265 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4266 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4267
4268http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4269
4270 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4271 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4272 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4273 example, or to pass some internal information.
4274 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4275 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4276 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4277
4278http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4279
4280 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4281 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4282
4283http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4284
4285 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4286
4287http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4288 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4289
4290 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4291
4292 Example:
4293 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4294
4295 # applied to:
4296 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4297
4298 # outputs:
4299 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4300
4301 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4302
4303http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4304 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4305
4306 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4307
4308 Example:
4309 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4310
4311 # applied to:
4312 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4313
4314 # outputs:
4315 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4316
4317http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4318
4319 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4320 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4321 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4322
4323http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4324 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4325
4326 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4327 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4328 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4329 fallback.
4330
4331 Example:
4332 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4333 http-response set-status 431
4334 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4335 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4336
4337http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4338
4339 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4340 inline.
4341
4342 Arguments:
4343 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4344 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4345 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4346 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4347 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4348 (request and response)
4349 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4350 processing
4351 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4352 processing
4353 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4354 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4355 and '_'.
4356
4357 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4358 followed by some converters.
4359
4360 Example:
4361 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4362
4363http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4364
4365 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4366 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4367 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4368 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4369 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004370 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004371 processing.
4372
4373 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4374 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4375 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4376 rules evaluation.
4377
4378http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4379
4380 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4381 details about <var-name>.
4382
4383 Example:
4384 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4385
4386
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004387http-check disable-on-404
4388 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004390 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004391 Arguments : none
4392
4393 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4394 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4395 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4396 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4397 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4398 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4399 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4400 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004401 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4402 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4403 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4404
4405 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4406
4407
4408http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004409 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004411 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004412 Arguments :
4413 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4414 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004415 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004416 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4417 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4418 details on the supported keywords.
4419
4420 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4421 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4422 with the usual backslash ('\').
4423
4424 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4425 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4426 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4427 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4428 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4429
4430 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004431 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004432 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4433 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4434 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4435
4436 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004437 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004438 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4439 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4440 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4441 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4442
4443 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004444 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004445 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4446 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4447 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4448 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4449 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004450 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004451 trace).
4452
4453 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004454 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004455 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4456 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4457 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4458 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4459 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004460 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004461
4462 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4463 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4464 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4465 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4466 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4467 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4468 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4469 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4470
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004471 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4472 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4473 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4474
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004475 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4476 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4477
4478 Examples :
4479 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004480 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004481
4482 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004483 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004484
4485 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004486 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004487
4488 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004489 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004490
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004491 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004492
4493
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004494http-check send [hdr <name> <value>]* [body <string>]
4495 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4496 health checks.
4497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4498 yes | no | yes | yes
4499 Arguments :
4500 hdr <name> <value> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4501 <name> and whose value is defined by <value> to the
4502 request sent during HTTP health checks.
4503
4504 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent
4505 sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4506 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added
4507 to the request.
4508
4509 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4510 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4511 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
4512 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. The old trick consisting to
4513 add headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
4514 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4515 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4516 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4517
4518 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect"
4519
4520
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004521http-check send-state
4522 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4524 yes | no | yes | yes
4525 Arguments : none
4526
4527 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4528 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4529 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4530 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4531 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4532
4533 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4534 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4535 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4536 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4537 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004538 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4539 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4540 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4541
4542 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4543 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4544 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4545
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004546 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4547 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4548 checked in multiple backends.
4549
4550 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4551 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4552
4553 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4554 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4555 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4556 one fails.
4557
4558 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4559 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4560 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4561
4562 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4563 server's queue.
4564
4565 Example of a header received by the application server :
4566 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4567 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4568
4569 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004571
4572http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004573 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4574
4575 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4576 no | yes | yes | yes
4577
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004578 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4579 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4580 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4581 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4582 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004584 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4585 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004587 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004589 Example:
4590 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4591 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4592 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004594 http-request allow if nagios
4595 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4596 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4597 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004599 Example:
4600 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4601 acl add path /addacl
4602 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004604 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004606 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4607 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004609 Example:
4610 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4611 acl setmap path /setmap
4612 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004614 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004616 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4617 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4620 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004621
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004622http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004624 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4625 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4626 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4627 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4628 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4629 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4630 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4631 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004633http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004635 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4636 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4637 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4638 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4639 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4640 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4641 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4642 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004644http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004646 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4647 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004648
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004650http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004652 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4653 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4654 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4655 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4656 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004657
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004658 Example:
4659 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4660 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004661
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004662http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004663
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004664 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004666http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4667 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004669 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4670 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4671 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4672 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4673 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4674 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4675 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4676 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4677 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004679 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4680 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4681 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004682 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4683
4684 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4685 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4686 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4687 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004688
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004689http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004691 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4692 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4693 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4694 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4695 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4696 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004698http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004700 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004702http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004703
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004704 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4705 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4706 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4707 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4708 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4709 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004710
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004711http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4712 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004714 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4715 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4716 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004717 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4718 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4719 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4720 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4721 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004722 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004723
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004724http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4725 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4726 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4727 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4728
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004729http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4730
4731 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4732 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4733 pointed by <resolvers>.
4734 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4735 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4736 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4737 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4738 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4739 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4740 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4741 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4742 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4743 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4744 to 0.0.0.0.
4745
4746 Example:
4747 resolvers mydns
4748 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4749 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4750 timeout retry 1s
4751 hold valid 10s
4752 hold nx 3s
4753 hold other 3s
4754 hold obsolete 0s
4755 accepted_payload_size 8192
4756
4757 frontend fe
4758 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4759 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4760 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4761
4762 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4763 # which mean DNS resolution error
4764 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4765
4766 default_backend be
4767
4768 backend b_503
4769 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4770 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4771 # 503 error page to end users
4772
4773 backend be
4774 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4775 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4776 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4777 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4778 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4779
4780 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4781 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4782
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004783http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4784
4785 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4786 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4787 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4788 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004789 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4790 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004791
4792 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004794http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004796 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4797 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4798 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4799 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4800 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004802http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004803
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004804 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4805 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4806 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4807 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004808
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004809http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4810 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004811
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004812 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004813 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4814 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4815 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4816 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4817 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004818
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004819 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4820 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4821 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4822 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4823 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004824
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004825 Example:
4826 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4827
4828 # applied to:
4829 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4830
4831 # outputs:
4832 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4833
4834 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004835
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004836 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4837
4838 # applied to:
4839 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004840
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004841 # outputs:
4842 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004843
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004844http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4845 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4846
4847 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4848 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4849 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4850 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4851
4852 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4853 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4854 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4855
4856 Example:
4857 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4858 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4859
4860 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4861 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4862
4863 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4864 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4865 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4866 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4867
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004868http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4869 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4870
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004871 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4872 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4873 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4874 against.
4875
4876 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4877 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4878 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004879
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004880 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4881 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4882 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4883 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4884 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4885 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4886 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4887 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4888 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004889 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4890 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004891
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004892 Example:
4893 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4894 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004895
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004896 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4897 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004898
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004899http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4900 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004901
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004902 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4903 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4904 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4905 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004906
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004907 Example:
4908 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004909
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004910 # applied to:
4911 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004912
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004913 # outputs:
4914 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004915
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004916http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
4917 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4918 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004919 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004920 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4921
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004922 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004923 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
4924 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
4925 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
4926 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004927 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004928 are followed to create the response :
4929
4930 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
4931 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
4932 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4933 ignored.
4934
4935 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
4936 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
4937 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
4938 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4939 ignored.
4940
4941 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
4942 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
4943 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
4944 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
4945 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
4946
4947 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
4948 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
4949 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
4950 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
4951 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
4952 if any, is ignored.
4953
4954 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
4955 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
4956 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
4957 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
4958 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
4959 as a raw content.
4960
4961 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
4962 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
4963 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
4964 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
4965 considered as a raw string.
4966
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004967 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
4968 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
4969 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
4970 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
4971
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004972 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
4973 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
4974 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
4975
4976 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4977
4978 Example:
4979 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
4980 if { path /ping }
4981
4982 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
4983 if { path /favicon.ico }
4984
4985 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
4986 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
4987 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
4988
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004989http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4990http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004991
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004992 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4993 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4994 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004995
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004996http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4997 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004998
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004999 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5000 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5001 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5002 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005004http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005005
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005006 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5007 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5008 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5009 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5010 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005011
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005012 Arguments:
5013 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5014 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005016 Example:
5017 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5018 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005019
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005020 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5021 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005023http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005025 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5026 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5027 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005029 Arguments:
5030 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5031 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005032
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005033 Example:
5034 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5035 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005036
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005037 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5038 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5039 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005040
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005041http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005043 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5044 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5045 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5046 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5047 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005049 Example:
5050 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5051 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5052 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5053 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5054 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5055 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5056 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5057 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5058 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005059
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005060http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005062 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5063 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5064 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5065 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5066 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005067
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005068http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5069 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005071 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5072 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5073 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5074 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5075 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5076 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5077 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5078 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5079 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005081http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005083 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5084 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5085 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5086 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5087 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5088 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5089 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005091http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005092
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005093 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5094 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5095 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005097http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005098
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005099 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5100 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5101 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5102 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5103 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5104 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5105 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5106 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005107
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005108http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005110 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5111 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5112 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5113 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5114 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5115 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005116
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005117 Example :
5118 # prepend the host name before the path
5119 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005120
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005121http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005123 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5124 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5125 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5126 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5127 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005129http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005130
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005131 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5132 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5133 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5134 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5135 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5136 values have higher priority.
5137 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5138 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5139 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5140 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5141 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005143http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005145 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5146 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5147 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5148 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5149 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5150 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5151 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005153 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005154
5155 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005156 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5157 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005158
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005159http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5160 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5161 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5162 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005163 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5164 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005165
5166 Arguments :
5167 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5168 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005169
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005170 See also "option forwardfor".
5171
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005172 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005173 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5174 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5175
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005176 # After the masking this will track connections
5177 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5178 http-request track-sc0 src
5179
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005180 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5181 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5182
5183http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5184
5185 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5186 expression.
5187
5188 Arguments:
5189 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5190 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005191
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005192 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005193 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5194 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5195
5196 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5197 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5198 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5199
5200http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5201
5202 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5203 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5204 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5205 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5206 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5207 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5208 information from the request.
5209
5210 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5211
5212http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5213
5214 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5215 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5216 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5217 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5218 path and the query string.
5219 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5220
5221http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5222
5223 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5224 inline.
5225
5226 Arguments:
5227 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5228 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5229 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5230 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5231 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5232 (request and response)
5233 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5234 processing
5235 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5236 processing
5237 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5238 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5239 and '_'.
5240
5241 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5242 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005243
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005244 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005245 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005247http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5248 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005250 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5251 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5252 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5253 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5254 agent name must be used.
5255
5256 Arguments:
5257 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5258
5259 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5260 configuration.
5261
5262http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5263
5264 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5265 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5266 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5267 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5268 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5269 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5270 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5271 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5272 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5273 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5274 action.
5275 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5276 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5277 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5278 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5279 you fully understand how it works.
5280
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005281http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5282
5283 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5284 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5285 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5286 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5287 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005288 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005289 processing.
5290
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005291 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005292 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5293 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5294 rules evaluation.
5295
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005296http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5297 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005298
5299 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5300 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5301 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5302 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5303 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5304 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5305 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5306 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5307 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5308 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5309 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005310 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5311 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5312 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5313 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5314 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005315 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5316
5317http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5318http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5319http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5320
5321 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5322 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5323 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5324 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5325 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5326 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5327 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5328 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5329 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5330 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5331 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5332 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5333
5334 Arguments :
5335 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5336 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5337 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5338 select which table entry to update the counters.
5339
5340 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5341 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5342 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5343 that table until the session ends.
5344
5345 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5346 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5347 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5348 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5349 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5350 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5351 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5352 useful information.
5353
5354 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5355 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5356 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5357 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5358 checks that make use of it.
5359
5360http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5361
5362 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005363
5364 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005365 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005366
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005367http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5368
5369 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5370 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5371 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5372 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5373 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5374 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5375
5376 Arguments :
5377 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5378
5379 Example:
5380 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005382http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005384 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5385 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5386 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005387
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005388
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005389http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005390 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5391
5392 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5393 no | yes | yes | yes
5394
5395 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5396 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5397 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5398 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5399 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5400 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5401
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005402 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5403 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005404
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005405 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005406
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005407 Example:
5408 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005409
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005410 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005411
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005412 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5413 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005414
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005415 Example:
5416 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005417
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005418 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005419
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005420 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5421 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005422
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005423 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5424 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005425
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005426http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005427
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005428 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5429 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5430 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5431 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5432 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5433 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5434 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5435 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005436
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005437http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005438
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005439 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5440 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5441 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5442 example, or to pass some internal information.
5443 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5444 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5445 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005446
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005447http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005448
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005449 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5450 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005451
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005452http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005453
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005454 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005455
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005456http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005457
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005458 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5459 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5460 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5461 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5462 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5463 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5464 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005465
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005466 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5467 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5468 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5469 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5470 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005471
5472 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5473 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5474 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5475 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005476
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005477http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005478
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005479 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5480 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5481 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5482 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5483 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5484 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005485
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005486http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005487
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005488 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005489
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005490http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005491
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005492 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5493 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5494 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5495 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5496 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5497 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005498
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005499http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5500 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005501
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005502 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005503 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5504 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005505 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5506 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5507 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5508 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5509 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005510 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005511
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005512http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005513
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005514 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5515 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5516 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5517 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5518 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5519 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005520
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005521http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5522 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005523
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005524 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5525 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005526
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005527 Example:
5528 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005529
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005530 # applied to:
5531 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005532
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005533 # outputs:
5534 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005535
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005536 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005537
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005538http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5539 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005540
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005541 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005542 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005543
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005544 Example:
5545 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005546
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005547 # applied to:
5548 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005549
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005550 # outputs:
5551 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005552
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005553http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5554 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5555 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005556 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005557 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5558
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005559 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005560 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5561 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5562 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5563 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005564 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005565 are followed to create the response :
5566
5567 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5568 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5569 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5570 ignored.
5571
5572 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5573 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5574 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5575 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5576 ignored.
5577
5578 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5579 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5580 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5581 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5582 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5583
5584 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5585 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5586 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5587 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5588 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5589 if any, is ignored.
5590
5591 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5592 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5593 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5594 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5595 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5596 as a raw content.
5597
5598 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5599 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5600 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5601 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5602 considered as a raw string.
5603
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005604 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5605 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5606 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5607 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5608
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005609 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5610 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5611 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5612
5613 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5614
5615 Example:
5616 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5617 if { status eq 404 }
5618
5619 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5620 string "This is the end !" \
5621 if { status eq 500 }
5622
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005623http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5624http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005625
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005626 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5627 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5628 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005629
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005630http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5631 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005632
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005633 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5634 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5635 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5636 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005637
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005638http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005639
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005640 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5641 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5642 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5643 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5644 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005645
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005646 Arguments:
5647 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005648
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005649 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5650 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005651
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005652http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005653
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005654 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5655 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5656 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005657
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005658http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5659
5660 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5661 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5662 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5663 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5664 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5665
5666http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5667
5668 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5669 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5670 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5671 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5672 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5673 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5674 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5675 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5676 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5677
5678http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5679
5680 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5681 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5682 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5683 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5684 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5685 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5686 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5687
5688http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5689
5690 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5691 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5692 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5693 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5694 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5695 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5696 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5697 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5698
5699http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5700 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5701
5702 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5703 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5704 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5705 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005706
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005707 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005708 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5709 http-response set-status 431
5710 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5711 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005712
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005713http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005714
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005715 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5716 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5717 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5718 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5719 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5720 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5721 based on some information from the request.
5722
5723 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5724
5725http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5726
5727 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5728 inline.
5729
5730 Arguments:
5731 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5732 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5733 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5734 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5735 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5736 (request and response)
5737 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5738 processing
5739 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5740 processing
5741 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5742 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5743 and '_'.
5744
5745 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5746 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005747
5748 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005749 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005750
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005751http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005752
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005753 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5754 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5755 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5756 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5757 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5758 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5759 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5760 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5761 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5762 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5763 action.
5764 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5765 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5766 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5767 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5768 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005769
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005770http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5771
5772 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5773 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5774 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5775 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5776 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005777 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005778 processing.
5779
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005780 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005781 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5782 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5783 rules evaluation.
5784
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005785http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5786http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5787http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005788
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005789 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5790 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5791 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5792 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5793 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5794 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5795
5796http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5797
5798 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5799 about <var-name>.
5800
5801 Example:
5802 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5803
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005804
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005805http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5806 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5807
5808 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5809 yes | no | yes | yes
5810
5811 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005812 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5813 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5814 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005815
5816 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5817
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005818 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5819 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5820 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5821 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5822 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5823 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5824 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5825 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5826 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5827 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005828
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005829 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5830 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5831 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5832 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5833 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5834 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5835 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5836 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005837
5838 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5839 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5840 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5841 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5842 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5843 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5844 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5845 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005846 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005847 downsides of rare connection failures.
5848
5849 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5850 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5851 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5852 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5853 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5854 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005855 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005856 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5857 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5858 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5859 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5860 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5861
5862 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005863 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5864 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5865 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005866
5867 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005868 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005869
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005870 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5871 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005872
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005873 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005874
5875 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5876 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5877 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5878
5879 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5880
5881
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005882http-send-name-header [<header>]
5883 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005884 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5885 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005886 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005887 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5888
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005889 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5890 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5891 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5892 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5893 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5894 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5895 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5896 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5897 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5898 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5899 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5900 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5901 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5902 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5903 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5904 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005905
5906 See also : "server"
5907
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005908id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005909 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5911 no | yes | yes | yes
5912 Arguments : none
5913
5914 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5915 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5916 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005917
5918
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005919ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5920 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5921 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005922 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005923
5924 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5925 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5926 and running).
5927
5928 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5929 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5930 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005931 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005932 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5933
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005934 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5935 "unless" condition is met.
5936
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005937 Example:
5938 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5939 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5940 ignore-persist if url_static
5941
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005942 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5943
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005944load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5945 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5946 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5947 yes | no | yes | yes
5948
5949 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5950 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5951 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005952 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005953 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5954 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5955 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5956 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5957
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005958 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005959 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005960 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005961
5962 Arguments:
5963 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5964 named "server-state-file".
5965
5966 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5967 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5968 name is used as a file name.
5969
5970 none don't load any stat for this backend
5971
5972 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005973 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5974 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5975 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005976 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005977 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005978
5979 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5980 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5981
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005982 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005983
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005984 global
5985 stats socket /tmp/socket
5986 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005987
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005988 defaults
5989 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005990
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005991 backend bk
5992 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5993 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005994
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005995
5996 Then one can run :
5997
5998 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5999
6000 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6001
6002 1
6003 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6004 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6005 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6006
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006007 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006008
6009 global
6010 stats socket /tmp/socket
6011 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6012
6013 defaults
6014 load-server-state-from-file local
6015
6016 backend bk
6017 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6018 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6019
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006020
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006021 Then one can run :
6022
6023 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6024
6025 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6026
6027 1
6028 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6029 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6030 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6031
6032 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6033 "show servers state"
6034
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006035
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006036log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006037log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6038 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006039no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006040 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6042 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006043
6044 Prefix :
6045 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6046 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6047 prefix does not allow arguments.
6048
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006049 Arguments :
6050 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6051 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6052 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6053 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6054 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6055 parameter.
6056
6057 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6058 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6059
6060 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6061 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6062 standard syslog port).
6063
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006064 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6065 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6066 standard syslog port).
6067
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006068 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6069 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6070 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006071 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006072
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006073 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6074 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6075 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6076 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6077 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6078 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6079 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6080 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6081 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6082 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6083 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6084 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6085 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6086 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6087 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6088 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006089 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6090 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006091
6092 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6093 and "fd@2", see above.
6094
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006095 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6096 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6097 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6098 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6099 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6100 having the logs instantly available.
6101
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006102 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6103 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006104
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006105 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6106 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6107 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6108 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6109 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6110 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6111 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6112 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6113 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6114 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006115 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006116
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006117 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6118 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6119 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6120 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6121 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6122
6123 <sample_size>
6124 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6125 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6126 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6127 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6128 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6129
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006130 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6131 one of the following :
6132
6133 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6134 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6135
6136 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6137 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6138
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006139 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6140 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6141 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6142 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6143 systemd logger consumes.
6144
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006145 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6146 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6147 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6148 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6149
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006150 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6151
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006152 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6153 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6154 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6155
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006156 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6157 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6158 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6159 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006160
6161 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6162 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6163 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006164 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6165 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6166 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6167 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6168 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006169
6170 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6171
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006172 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6173 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6174 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006175
6176 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6177 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6178 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6179 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6180
6181 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6182 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006183
6184 Example :
6185 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006186 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6187 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6188 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006189 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6190 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006191 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006192
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006193
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006194log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006195 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6196 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6197 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006198
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006199 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6200 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6201 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6202 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6203 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006204
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006205 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6206 "option httplog" directives.
6207
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006208log-format-sd <string>
6209 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6210 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6211 yes | yes | yes | no
6212
6213 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6214 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6215 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6216 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6217 which covers the log format string in depth.
6218
6219 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6220 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6221
6222 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6223 log format to "rfc5424".
6224
6225 Example :
6226 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6227
6228
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006229log-tag <string>
6230 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6231 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6232 yes | yes | yes | yes
6233
6234 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6235 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6236 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6237 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6238 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6239 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6240 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6241 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6242 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006243
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006244max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6245 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6246 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6247 yes | no | yes | yes
6248
6249 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6250 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6251 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6252 servers.
6253
6254 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6255 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6256 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6257 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6258 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006259 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006260 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6261 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6262 picking a different server.
6263
6264 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6265 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6266 even if they have to be queued.
6267
6268 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6269 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6270
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006271max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6272 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6273 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6274 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006275
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006276maxconn <conns>
6277 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6279 yes | yes | yes | no
6280 Arguments :
6281 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6282 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6283 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6284 closes.
6285
6286 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6287 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6288 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6289 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006290 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6291 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6292 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6293 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006294
6295 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6296 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6297 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6298
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006299 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6300 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006301
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006302 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6303
6304
6305mode { tcp|http|health }
6306 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6308 yes | yes | yes | yes
6309 Arguments :
6310 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6311 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6312 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6313 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6314
6315 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6316 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6317 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6318 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6319 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6320
6321 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006322 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6323 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6324 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6325 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6326 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6327 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6328 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006329
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006330 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6331 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6332 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006333
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006334 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006335 defaults http_instances
6336 mode http
6337
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006338 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006340
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006341monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006342 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6344 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006345 Arguments :
6346 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6347 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006348 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006349 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6350 backend and its backup.
6351
6352 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6353 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6354 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6355 servers in a list of backends.
6356
6357 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6358 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6359 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6360 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6361 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6362 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6363 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006364 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6365 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006366
6367 Example:
6368 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006369 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006370 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6371 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6372 monitor-uri /site_alive
6373 monitor fail if site_dead
6374
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006375 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006376
6377
6378monitor-net <source>
6379 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6381 yes | yes | yes | no
6382 Arguments :
6383 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6384 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6385 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6386 followed by a mask.
6387
6388 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6389 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006390 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006391 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6392
6393 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6394 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6395 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6396 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006397 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6398 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6399 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006400
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006401 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6402 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6403 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6404 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6405 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6406 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006407
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006408 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6409 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006410
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006411 Example :
6412 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6413 frontend www
6414 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6415
6416 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6417
6418
6419monitor-uri <uri>
6420 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6422 yes | yes | yes | no
6423 Arguments :
6424 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6425 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6426
6427 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6428 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6429 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6430 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6431 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6432 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6433 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6434 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6435
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006436 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006437 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6438 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6439 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6440 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6441 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6442 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006443
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006444 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6445 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6446 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6447 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6448
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006449 Example :
6450 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6451 frontend www
6452 mode http
6453 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6454
6455 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6456
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006457
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006458option abortonclose
6459no option abortonclose
6460 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6462 yes | no | yes | yes
6463 Arguments : none
6464
6465 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6466 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6467 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6468 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006469 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006470 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6471 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6472 encountered while delivering the response.
6473
6474 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6475 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6476 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6477 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6478 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6479 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006480 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006481 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006482 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006483 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6484 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6485 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6486
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006487 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6488 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006489 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6490 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6491 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6492 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6493 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6494 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006495 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006496
6497 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6498 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6499
6500 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6501
6502
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006503option accept-invalid-http-request
6504no option accept-invalid-http-request
6505 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6507 yes | yes | yes | no
6508 Arguments : none
6509
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006510 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006511 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006512 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006513 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6514 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6515 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6516 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6517 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006518 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6519 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6520 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6521 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006522 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006523 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006524 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6525 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6526 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006527
6528 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6529 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6530 been confirmed.
6531
6532 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6533 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006534 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6535 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006536 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6537
6538 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6539 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6540
6541 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6542 stats socket.
6543
6544
6545option accept-invalid-http-response
6546no option accept-invalid-http-response
6547 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6549 yes | no | yes | yes
6550 Arguments : none
6551
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006552 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006553 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006554 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006555 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6556 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6557 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6558 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6559 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006560 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6561 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6562 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006563
6564 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6565 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6566 been confirmed.
6567
6568 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6569 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6570 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6571 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6572
6573 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6574 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6575
6576 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6577 stats socket.
6578
6579
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006580option allbackups
6581no option allbackups
6582 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6584 yes | no | yes | yes
6585 Arguments : none
6586
6587 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6588 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6589 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6590 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6591 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6592 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6593 order between the backup servers anymore.
6594
6595 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6596 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6597
6598 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6599 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6600
6601
6602option checkcache
6603no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006604 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6606 yes | no | yes | yes
6607 Arguments : none
6608
6609 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6610 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006611 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006612 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6613 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006614 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006615
6616 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006617 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006618 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006619 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6620 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006621 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006622 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006623 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6624 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006625 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006626 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6627 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006628 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006629 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6630 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6631 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6632 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6633 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6634 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6635 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6636 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6637 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6638
6639 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006640 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6641 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6642 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6643 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006644
6645 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6646 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006647 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006648 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006649
6650 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6651 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6652
6653
6654option clitcpka
6655no option clitcpka
6656 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6658 yes | yes | yes | no
6659 Arguments : none
6660
6661 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6662 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006663 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006664 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6665
6666 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6667 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6668 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6669 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6670
6671 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6672 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6673 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6674 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6675 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6676
6677 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6678
6679 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6680 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6681 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6682
6683 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6684 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6685
6686 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6687
6688
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006689option contstats
6690 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6692 yes | yes | yes | no
6693 Arguments : none
6694
6695 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6696 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6697 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6698 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006699 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6700 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6701 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6702 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6703 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006704
6705
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006706option dontlog-normal
6707no option dontlog-normal
6708 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6710 yes | yes | yes | no
6711 Arguments : none
6712
6713 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6714 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6715 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6716 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6717 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6718 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6719 logged.
6720
6721 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6722 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6723 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006725 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006726 logging.
6727
6728
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006729option dontlognull
6730no option dontlognull
6731 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6733 yes | yes | yes | no
6734 Arguments : none
6735
6736 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6737 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6738 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6739 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6740 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6741 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006742 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6743 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6744 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006745
6746 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006747 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006748 would not be logged.
6749
6750 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6751 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6752
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006753 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6754 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006755
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006756
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006757option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006758 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6760 yes | yes | yes | yes
6761 Arguments :
6762 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6763 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006764 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006765 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006766
6767 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6768 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6769 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6770 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6771 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6772 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6773 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006774 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6775 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6776 possible that the client has already brought one.
6777
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006778 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006779 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006780 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006781 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006782 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006783 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006784
6785 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6786 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6787 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6788 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6789 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6790 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6791 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6792
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006793 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6794 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6795 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6796 are under the control of the end-user.
6797
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006798 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006799 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6800 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006801 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6802 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6803 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006804
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006805 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006806 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6807 frontend www
6808 mode http
6809 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6810
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006811 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6812 backend www
6813 mode http
6814 option forwardfor header X-Client
6815
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006816 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006817 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006818
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006819
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006820option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6821no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6822 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6824 yes | yes | yes | no
6825 Arguments : none
6826
6827 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6828 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6829 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6830 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6831 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6832 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6833 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6834
6835 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6836 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6837 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6838 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6839 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6840 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6841 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6842 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6843 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6844 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6845
6846 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6847
6848 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6849 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6850
6851 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6852 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6853
6854
6855option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6856no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6857 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6859 yes | no | yes | yes
6860 Arguments : none
6861
6862 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6863 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6864 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6865 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6866 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6867 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6868 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6869
6870 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6871 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6872 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6873 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6874 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6875 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6876 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6877 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6878 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6879 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6880
6881 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6882
6883 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6884 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6885
6886 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6887 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6888
6889
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006890option http-buffer-request
6891no option http-buffer-request
6892 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6894 yes | yes | yes | yes
6895 Arguments : none
6896
6897 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6898 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6899 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6900 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6901 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6902 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006903 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6904 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6905 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6906 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006907
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006908 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006909
6910
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006911option http-ignore-probes
6912no option http-ignore-probes
6913 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6915 yes | yes | yes | no
6916 Arguments : none
6917
6918 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6919 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6920 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6921 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6922 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6923 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6924 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6925 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6926 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006927 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6928 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006929 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6930
6931 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6932 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6933 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6934 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6935 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6936 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6937 are often the only way to detect them.
6938
6939 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6940 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6941
6942 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6943
6944
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006945option http-keep-alive
6946no option http-keep-alive
6947 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6949 yes | yes | yes | yes
6950 Arguments : none
6951
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006952 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6953 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006954 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6955 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006956 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6957 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6958 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006959
6960 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6961 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006962 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6963 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6964 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6965 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6966 situations where this option may be useful :
6967
6968 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006969 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006970
6971 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6972 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6973
6974 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6975 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6976 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6977 request.
6978
6979 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6980 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006981 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6982 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6983 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006984
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006985 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6986 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6987 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6988 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6989 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6990 not set.
6991
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006992 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6993 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6994 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006995
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006996 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006997 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006998 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006999
7000
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007001option http-no-delay
7002no option http-no-delay
7003 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7005 yes | yes | yes | yes
7006 Arguments : none
7007
7008 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7009 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7010 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7011 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7012 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7013 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7014 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7015 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7016 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7017 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7018 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7019 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7020 affected.
7021
7022 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7023 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7024 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7025 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7026 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7027 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7028 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7029 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7030 latency environments.
7031
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007032 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7033
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007034
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007035option http-pretend-keepalive
7036no option http-pretend-keepalive
7037 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007039 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007040 Arguments : none
7041
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007042 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007043 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7044 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7045 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7046 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7047 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7048 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7049 consider the response complete.
7050
7051 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7052 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7053 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7054 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007055 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007056 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7057
7058 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7059 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7060 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7061 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7062 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7063 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7064 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7065
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007066 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7067 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7068 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7069 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7070 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7071 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007072
7073 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7074 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7075
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007076 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007077 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007078
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007079
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007080option http-server-close
7081no option http-server-close
7082 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7084 yes | yes | yes | yes
7085 Arguments : none
7086
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007087 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7088 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7089 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7090 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007091 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7092 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7093 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7094 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7095 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7096 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7097 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7098 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7099 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7100 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7101 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007102
7103 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7104 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7105 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7106 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007107 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7108 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007109
7110 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7111 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007112 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7113 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7114 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007115
7116 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7117 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7118
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007119 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7120 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007121
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007122option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007123no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007124 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7126 yes | yes | yes | no
7127 Arguments : none
7128
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007129 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007130 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7131 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7132 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7133 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7134 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7135 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7136
7137 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7138 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007139 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7140 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7141 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007142
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007143 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7144 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7145 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7146 front of an existing proxy.
7147
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007148 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7149
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007150 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007151
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007152option httpchk
7153option httpchk <uri>
7154option httpchk <method> <uri>
7155option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
7156 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
7157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7158 yes | no | yes | yes
7159 Arguments :
7160 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7161 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7162 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7163 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7164 ones.
7165
7166 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7167 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7168 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7169
7170 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7171 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7172 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007173 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007174
7175 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7176 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7177 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7178 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7179 the lack of any response.
7180
7181 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
7182
7183 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
7184 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
7185 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
7186
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007187 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7188 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7189 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7190 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7191
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007192 Examples :
7193 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7194 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7195 backend https_relay
7196 mode tcp
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007197 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7198 http-check send hdr Host www
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007199 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
7200
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007201 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7202 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7203 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007204
7205
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007206option httpclose
7207no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007208 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7210 yes | yes | yes | yes
7211 Arguments : none
7212
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007213 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7214 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7215 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7216 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007217 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007218
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007219 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7220 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007221 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007222 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7223 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007224
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007225 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7226 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7227 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007228
7229 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7230 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007231 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7232 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7233 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007234
7235 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7236 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7237
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007238 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007239
7240
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007241option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007242 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007244 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007245 Arguments :
7246 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7247 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7248 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007249 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007250 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007251
7252 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7253 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7254 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7255 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7256 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7257 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7258 ports.
7259
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007260 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7261 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007262
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007263 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007265 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007266
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007267
7268option http_proxy
7269no option http_proxy
7270 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7272 yes | yes | yes | yes
7273 Arguments : none
7274
7275 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7276 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7277 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7278 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7279 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7280
7281 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7282 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007283 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7284 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007285
7286 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7287 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7288
7289 Example :
7290 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7291 backend direct_forward
7292 option httpclose
7293 option http_proxy
7294
7295 See also : "option httpclose"
7296
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007297
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007298option independent-streams
7299no option independent-streams
7300 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7302 yes | yes | yes | yes
7303 Arguments : none
7304
7305 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7306 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7307 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7308 receive data or not.
7309
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007310 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007311 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7312 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7313 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7314 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7315 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7316 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7317 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7318 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7319 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7320 socket buffers.
7321
7322 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7323 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7324 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7325 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7326 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7327
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007328 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007329
7330
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007331option ldap-check
7332 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7334 yes | no | yes | yes
7335 Arguments : none
7336
7337 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7338 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7339 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7340 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7341
7342 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7343 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7344
7345 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7346 configure it.
7347
7348 Example :
7349 option ldap-check
7350
7351 See also : "option httpchk"
7352
7353
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007354option external-check
7355 Use external processes for server health checks
7356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7357 yes | no | yes | yes
7358
7359 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7360 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7361 command".
7362
7363 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7364
7365 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7366
7367
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007368option log-health-checks
7369no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007370 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7372 yes | no | yes | yes
7373 Arguments : none
7374
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007375 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7376 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7377 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007378
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007379 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7380 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7381 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7382 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7383 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7384
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007385 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007386 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007387
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007388 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7389 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7390 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007391
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007392
7393option log-separate-errors
7394no option log-separate-errors
7395 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7397 yes | yes | yes | no
7398 Arguments : none
7399
7400 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7401 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7402 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7403 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7404 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7405 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7406 provides very important information.
7407
7408 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7409 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7410 error logs.
7411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007412 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007413 logging.
7414
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007415
7416option logasap
7417no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007418 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7420 yes | yes | yes | no
7421 Arguments : none
7422
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007423 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7424 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7425 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7426 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7427
7428 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7429 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7430 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7431 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7432 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7433 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7434 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7435 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7436 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7437 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7438 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007439
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007440 Examples :
7441 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7442 mode http
7443 option httplog
7444 option logasap
7445 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7446
7447 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7448 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7449 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7450 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007452 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007453 logging.
7454
7455
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007456option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007457 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7459 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007460 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007461 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7462 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007463 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007464
7465 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7466 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007467 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007468 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7469 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7470 in the MySQL table, like this :
7471
7472 USE mysql;
7473 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7474 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7475
7476 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007477 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007478 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7479 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7480 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7481 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7482 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7483 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7484 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7485
7486 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7487 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007488
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007489 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007490
7491 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7492 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7493 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7494 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007495 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7496 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007497
7498 See also: "option httpchk"
7499
7500
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007501option nolinger
7502no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007503 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007504 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7505 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007506 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007507
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007508 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007509 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7510 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7511 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7512 connections.
7513
7514 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7515 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7516 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7517 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7518 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7519 this too.
7520
7521 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7522 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7523 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7524
7525 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7526 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7527 for servers.
7528
7529 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7530 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7531
7532
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007533option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7534 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7536 yes | yes | yes | yes
7537 Arguments :
7538 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7539 matching <network>
7540 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7541 header name.
7542
7543 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7544 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7545 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7546 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7547 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7548 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7549 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7550 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7551 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7552 possible that the client has already brought one.
7553
7554 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7555 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7556 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7557 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7558 header and requires different one.
7559
7560 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7561 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7562 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7563 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7564 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7565 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7566 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7567
7568 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7569 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7570 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7571 both are defined.
7572
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007573 Examples :
7574 # Original Destination address
7575 frontend www
7576 mode http
7577 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7578
7579 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7580 backend www
7581 mode http
7582 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7583
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007584 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007585
7586
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007587option persist
7588no option persist
7589 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7590 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7591 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007592 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007593
7594 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7595 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7596 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7597 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7598 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7599 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7600 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7601 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7602 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7603 redirected to another valid server.
7604
7605 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7606 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7607
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007608 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007609
7610
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007611option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7612 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7614 yes | no | yes | yes
7615 Arguments :
7616 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7617 PostgreSQL server.
7618
7619 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7620 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7621 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7622 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7623
7624 See also: "option httpchk"
7625
7626
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007627option prefer-last-server
7628no option prefer-last-server
7629 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7630 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7631 yes | no | yes | yes
7632 Arguments : none
7633
7634 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7635 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7636 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7637 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7638 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7639 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7640 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7641 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7642 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007643 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7644 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007645 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7646 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7647 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007648 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7649 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7650 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007651
7652 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7653 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7654
7655 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7656
7657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007658option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007659option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007660no option redispatch
7661 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7662 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7663 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007664 Arguments :
7665 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7666 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7667 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007668 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007669 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007670 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007671 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7672 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7673 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7674
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007675
7676 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7677 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7678 be able to access the service anymore.
7679
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007680 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7681 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007682
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02007683 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
7684 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
7685 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
7686 following order:
7687
7688 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
7689
7690 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
7691 list, or
7692
7693 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
7694
7695 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
7696 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
7697
7698 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
7699 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
7700 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
7701 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
7702
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007703 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007704 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7705 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007707 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7708 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7709
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007710 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007711
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007712
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007713option redis-check
7714 Use redis health checks for server testing
7715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7716 yes | no | yes | yes
7717 Arguments : none
7718
7719 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7720 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7721 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7722 find the "+PONG" response message.
7723
7724 Example :
7725 option redis-check
7726
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007727 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007728
7729
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007730option smtpchk
7731option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7732 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7734 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007735 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007736 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007737 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007738 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7739
7740 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7741 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7742 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7743
7744 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7745 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7746 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7747 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7748 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7749 dead server.
7750
7751 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7752 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007753 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007754 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7755
7756 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7757 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7758 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7759 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007760 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007761
7762 Example :
7763 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7764
7765 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007767
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007768option socket-stats
7769no option socket-stats
7770
7771 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7773 yes | yes | yes | no
7774
7775 Arguments : none
7776
7777
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007778option splice-auto
7779no option splice-auto
7780 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7782 yes | yes | yes | yes
7783 Arguments : none
7784
7785 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7786 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007787 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007788 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007789 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007790 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7791 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7792 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7793 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7794
7795 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7796 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7797 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7798 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7799 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7800 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7801 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7802 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7803 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7804 keyword.
7805
7806 Example :
7807 option splice-auto
7808
7809 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7810 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7811
7812 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7813 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7814
7815
7816option splice-request
7817no option splice-request
7818 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7820 yes | yes | yes | yes
7821 Arguments : none
7822
7823 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007824 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007825 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7826 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7827 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7828 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7829
7830 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7831
7832 Example :
7833 option splice-request
7834
7835 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7836 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7837
7838 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7839 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7840
7841
7842option splice-response
7843no option splice-response
7844 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7846 yes | yes | yes | yes
7847 Arguments : none
7848
7849 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007850 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007851 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7852 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7853 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7854 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7855
7856 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7857
7858 Example :
7859 option splice-response
7860
7861 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7862 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7863
7864 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7865 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7866
7867
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007868option spop-check
7869 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7871 no | no | no | yes
7872 Arguments : none
7873
7874 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7875 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7876 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7877 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7878
7879 Example :
7880 option spop-check
7881
7882 See also : "option httpchk"
7883
7884
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007885option srvtcpka
7886no option srvtcpka
7887 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7889 yes | no | yes | yes
7890 Arguments : none
7891
7892 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7893 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007894 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007895 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7896
7897 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7898 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7899 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7900 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7901
7902 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7903 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7904 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7905 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7906 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7907
7908 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7909
7910 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7911 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7912 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7913
7914 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7915 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7916
7917 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7918
7919
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007920option ssl-hello-chk
7921 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7923 yes | no | yes | yes
7924 Arguments : none
7925
7926 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7927 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7928 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7929 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7930 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7931 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7932 hello message.
7933
7934 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7935 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7936 messages, which is appreciable.
7937
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007938 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7939 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7940 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007941
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007942 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7943
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007944
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007945option tcp-check
7946 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7947 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7948 yes | no | yes | yes
7949
7950 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7951 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7952
7953 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7954 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7955 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7956
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007957 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007958 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7959 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7960 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7961 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7962 only.
7963
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007964 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007965 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7966 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7967 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7968 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7969
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007970 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007971 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7972 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007973 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007974 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7975 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7976 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7977 the respective protocols.
7978 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007979 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007980
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007981 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7982 script.
7983
7984 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7985 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7986 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7987 The "comment" is of course optional.
7988
7989
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007990 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007991 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007992 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007993 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007994
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007995 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007996 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007997 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007998
7999 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8000 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008001 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008002 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008003 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008004 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008005 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008006 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008007 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8008 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008009 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008010 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8011 tcp-check expect string +OK
8012
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008013 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008014 (send many headers before analyzing)
8015 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008016 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008017 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8018 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8019 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8020 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008021 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008022
8023
8024 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
8025
8026
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008027option tcp-smart-accept
8028no option tcp-smart-accept
8029 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8031 yes | yes | yes | no
8032 Arguments : none
8033
8034 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8035 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8036 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8037 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8038 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8039 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8040
8041 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8042 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8043 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8044 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8045
8046 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8047 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8048 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008049 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008050
8051 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8052 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8053 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8054
8055 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8056 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8057 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8058
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008059 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8060
8061
8062option tcp-smart-connect
8063no option tcp-smart-connect
8064 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8066 yes | no | yes | yes
8067 Arguments : none
8068
8069 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8070 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8071 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8072 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8073 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8074
8075 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8076 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8077 complex.
8078
8079 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8080 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8081 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8082
8083 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8084 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8085
8086 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8087
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008088
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008089option tcpka
8090 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8092 yes | yes | yes | yes
8093 Arguments : none
8094
8095 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8096 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008097 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008098 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8099
8100 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8101 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8102 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8103 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8104
8105 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8106 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8107 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8108 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8109 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8110
8111 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8112
8113 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8114 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8115 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8116 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8117 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8118 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8119 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8120 backends.
8121
8122 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8123
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008124
8125option tcplog
8126 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008128 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008129 Arguments : none
8130
8131 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8132 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8133 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8134 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8135 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8136 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8137 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8138 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8139
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008140 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008142 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008143
8144
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008145option transparent
8146no option transparent
8147 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008149 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008150 Arguments : none
8151
8152 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8153 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8154 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8155 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8156 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8157 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8158 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8159 appropriate server.
8160
8161 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8162 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8163
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008164 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008165 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008166
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008167
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008168external-check command <command>
8169 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8171 yes | no | yes | yes
8172
8173 Arguments :
8174 <command> is the external command to run
8175
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008176 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8177
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008178 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008179
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008180 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8181 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8182 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8183 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8184 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8185 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008186
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008187 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8188
8189 Environment variables :
8190 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8191 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8192
8193 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8194
8195 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8196
8197 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8198 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8199 for a UNIX socket).
8200
8201 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8202
8203 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8204
8205 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8206
8207 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8208
8209 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8210
8211 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8212 socket).
8213
8214 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8215 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8216
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008217 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8218
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008219 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8220 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8221 failed.
8222
8223 Example :
8224 external-check command /bin/true
8225
8226 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8227
8228
8229external-check path <path>
8230 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8232 yes | no | yes | yes
8233
8234 Arguments :
8235 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8236
8237 The default path is "".
8238
8239 Example :
8240 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8241
8242 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8243 "external-check command"
8244
8245
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008246persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008247persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008248 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8250 yes | no | yes | yes
8251 Arguments :
8252 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008253 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8254 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008255
8256 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8257 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008258 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008259 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8260 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8261 forwarded to this server.
8262
8263 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8264 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8265 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008266 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008267 a single "listen" section.
8268
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008269 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8270 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8271 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8272
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008273 Example :
8274 listen tse-farm
8275 bind :3389
8276 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8277 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8278 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8279 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8280 persist rdp-cookie
8281 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008282 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008283 balance rdp-cookie
8284 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8285 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8286
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008287 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8288 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008289
8290
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008291rate-limit sessions <rate>
8292 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8294 yes | yes | yes | no
8295 Arguments :
8296 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8297 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8298
8299 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8300 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8301 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8302 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8303 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8304 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8305
8306 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8307 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8308 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8309 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8310
8311 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8312 listen smtp
8313 mode tcp
8314 bind :25
8315 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008316 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008317
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008318 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8319 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8320 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008321
8322 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8323
8324
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008325redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8326redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8327redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008328 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8330 no | yes | yes | yes
8331
8332 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008333 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008334
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008335 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008336 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008337 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8338 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8339 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008340
8341 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8342 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8343 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8344 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8345 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008346 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8347 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8348 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8349 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008350
8351 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8352 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8353 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8354 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8355 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8356 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008357 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008358 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008359 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8360 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8361 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008362
8363 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008364 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8365 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8366 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008367 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008368 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8369 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8370 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8371 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008372
8373 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008374 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008375
8376 - "drop-query"
8377 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8378 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8379 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8380 with a location-type redirect.
8381
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008382 - "append-slash"
8383 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8384 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8385 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8386 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8387
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008388 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8389 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8390 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8391 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8392 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8393 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8394 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8395
8396 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8397 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8398 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8399 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8400 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8401 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8402 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008403
8404 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8405 acl clear dst_port 80
8406 acl secure dst_port 8080
8407 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008408 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008409 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008410 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8411
8412 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008413 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8414 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8415 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008416 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008417
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008418 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8419 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8420 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8421
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008422 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008423 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008424
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008425 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008426 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8427 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8428 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008430 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008431
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008432
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008433retries <value>
8434 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8435 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8436 yes | no | yes | yes
8437 Arguments :
8438 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8439 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8440 default value is 3.
8441
8442 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8443 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8444 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8445
8446 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008447 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8448 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008449
8450 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8451 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8452
8453 See also : "option redispatch"
8454
8455
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008456retry-on [list of keywords]
8457 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8458 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8459 yes | no | yes | yes
8460 Arguments :
8461 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8462 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8463 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8464 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8465
8466 none never retry
8467
8468 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8469 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8470
8471 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8472 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8473 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8474 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8475 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8476 processing the request.
8477
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008478 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8479 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8480 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8481 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8482 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8483 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8484 overflow attack for example).
8485
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008486 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8487 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8488 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8489 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8490 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8491 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8492 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8493 amplify denial of service attacks.
8494
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008495 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8496 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8497 considered to be safe to retry.
8498
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008499 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8500 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8501 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8502 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8503
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008504 all-retryable-errors
8505 retry request for any error that are considered
8506 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8507 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8508 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8509
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008510 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8511 not cumulative.
8512
8513 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8514 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8515 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8516 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8517
8518 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8519 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8520 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8521 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8522 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8523 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8524 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8525 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8526 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8527 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8528 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8529 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8530
8531 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8532 should not use this directive.
8533
8534 The default is "conn-failure".
8535
8536 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8537
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008538server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008539 Declare a server in a backend
8540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8541 no | no | yes | yes
8542 Arguments :
8543 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008544 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008545 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008546
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008547 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8548 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8549 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8550 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008551 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8552 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8553 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8554 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8555 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008556 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8557 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8558 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8559 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8560 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8561 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8562 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008563 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008564 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8565 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8566 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8567 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8568 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8569 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008570 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8571 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008572 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8573 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008574
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008575 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008576 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8577 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8578 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8579 adding this value to the client's port.
8580
8581 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8582 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008583 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008584
8585 Examples :
8586 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8587 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008588 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008589 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8590 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8591 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008592
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008593 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8594 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8595 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8596 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8597 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8598
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008599 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8600 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008601
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008602server-state-file-name [<file>]
8603 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8604 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8605 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8606 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8607 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8608 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8609
8610 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8611 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8612
8613 global
8614 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8615
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008616 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008617 load-server-state-from-file
8618
8619 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8620 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008621
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008622server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8623 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8624 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8626 no | no | yes | yes
8627
8628 Arguments:
8629 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8630
8631 <num | range>
8632 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8633 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8634 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8635 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8636
8637 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8638
8639 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8640
8641 <params*>
8642 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8643 keyword.
8644
8645 Examples:
8646 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8647 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8648 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8649
8650 # or
8651 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8652
8653 # would be equivalent to:
8654 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8655 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8656 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8657
8658
8659
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008660source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008661source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008662source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008663 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8665 yes | no | yes | yes
8666 Arguments :
8667 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8668 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008669
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008670 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008671 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8672 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8673 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8674 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8675 supported prefixes are :
8676 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8677 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8678 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008679 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008680 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8681 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008682
8683 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8684 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008685 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8686 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8687 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008688
8689 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8690 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8691 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8692 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8693 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8694 <addr>.
8695
8696 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8697 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8698 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8699 port.
8700
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008701 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8702 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8703 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8704 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008705 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008706 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8707 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8708 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8709 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8710 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8711 HTTP header.
8712
8713 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8714 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008715 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008716 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8717 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8718 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8719 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8720 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8721 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8722 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8723
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008724 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8725 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8726 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8727 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8728 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8729 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8730
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008731 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8732 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8733 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8734 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8735
8736 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8737 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8738 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8739 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8740 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8741 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8742
8743 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8744 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8745 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8746 there are two methods :
8747
8748 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8749 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8750 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8751 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8752 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8753 of the client ranges may be used.
8754
8755 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8756 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8757 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8758 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8759 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8760 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8761 same session.
8762
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008763 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8764 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8765 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008766 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008767
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008768 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8769
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008770 Examples :
8771 backend private
8772 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8773 source 192.168.1.200
8774
8775 backend transparent_ssl1
8776 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8777 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8778
8779 backend transparent_ssl2
8780 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8781 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8782 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8783
8784 backend transparent_ssl3
8785 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8786 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8787 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8788
8789 backend transparent_smtp
8790 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8791 # with Tproxy version 4.
8792 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8793
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008794 backend transparent_http
8795 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8796 # proxy.
8797 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008799 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008800 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8801
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008802
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008803stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8804 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008806 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008807
8808 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8809 matched.
8810
8811 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8812 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8813
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008814 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8815 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008816 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008817
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008818 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8819 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8820 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8821 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008822
8823 Example :
8824 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8825 backend stats_localhost
8826 stats enable
8827 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8828
8829 Example :
8830 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8831 backend stats_auth
8832 stats enable
8833 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8834 stats admin if TRUE
8835
8836 Example :
8837 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8838 userlist stats-auth
8839 group admin users admin
8840 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8841 group readonly users haproxy
8842 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8843
8844 backend stats_auth
8845 stats enable
8846 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8847 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8848 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8849 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8850
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008851 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8852 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8853 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008854
8855
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008856stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8857 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008859 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008860 Arguments :
8861 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8862
8863 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8864
8865 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8866 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8867 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8868 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8869 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8870 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8871
8872 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8873 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8874 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008875 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008876
8877 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8878 report using "stats scope".
8879
8880 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8881 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8882 unobvious parameters.
8883
8884 Example :
8885 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8886 backend public_www
8887 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8888 stats enable
8889 stats hide-version
8890 stats scope .
8891 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008892 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008893 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8894 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8895
8896 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8897 backend private_monitoring
8898 stats enable
8899 stats uri /admin?stats
8900 stats refresh 5s
8901
8902 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8903
8904
8905stats enable
8906 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008908 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008909 Arguments : none
8910
8911 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8912 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8913 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8914 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8915 - stats auth : no authentication
8916 - stats scope : no restriction
8917
8918 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8919 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8920 unobvious parameters.
8921
8922 Example :
8923 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8924 backend public_www
8925 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8926 stats enable
8927 stats hide-version
8928 stats scope .
8929 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008930 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008931 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8932 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8933
8934 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8935 backend private_monitoring
8936 stats enable
8937 stats uri /admin?stats
8938 stats refresh 5s
8939
8940 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8941
8942
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008943stats hide-version
8944 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008946 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008947 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008948
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008949 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8950 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8951 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8952 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8953 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8954 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008956 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8957 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8958 unobvious parameters.
8959
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008960 Example :
8961 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8962 backend public_www
8963 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008964 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008965 stats hide-version
8966 stats scope .
8967 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008968 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008969 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8970 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008971
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008972 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8973 backend private_monitoring
8974 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008975 stats uri /admin?stats
8976 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008977
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008978 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008979
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008980
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008981stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8982 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8983 Access control for statistics
8984
8985 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8986 no | no | yes | yes
8987
8988 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8989 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8990 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8991 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8992 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8993 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8994
8995 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8996 instance.
8997
8998 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8999 about ACL usage.
9000
9001
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009002stats realm <realm>
9003 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009005 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009006 Arguments :
9007 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9008 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9009 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9010
9011 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9012 using a backslash ('\').
9013
9014 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9015 only related to authentication.
9016
9017 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9018 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9019 unobvious parameters.
9020
9021 Example :
9022 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9023 backend public_www
9024 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9025 stats enable
9026 stats hide-version
9027 stats scope .
9028 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009029 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009030 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9031 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9032
9033 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9034 backend private_monitoring
9035 stats enable
9036 stats uri /admin?stats
9037 stats refresh 5s
9038
9039 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9040
9041
9042stats refresh <delay>
9043 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009045 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009046 Arguments :
9047 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9048 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9049 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9050 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9051 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9052 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9053
9054 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9055 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9056 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9057 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9058
9059 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9060 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9061 unobvious parameters.
9062
9063 Example :
9064 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9065 backend public_www
9066 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9067 stats enable
9068 stats hide-version
9069 stats scope .
9070 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009071 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009072 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9073 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9074
9075 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9076 backend private_monitoring
9077 stats enable
9078 stats uri /admin?stats
9079 stats refresh 5s
9080
9081 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9082
9083
9084stats scope { <name> | "." }
9085 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009087 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009088 Arguments :
9089 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9090 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9091 section in which the statement appears.
9092
9093 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9094 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9095 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9096 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9097 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9098 exists.
9099
9100 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9101 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9102 unobvious parameters.
9103
9104 Example :
9105 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9106 backend public_www
9107 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9108 stats enable
9109 stats hide-version
9110 stats scope .
9111 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009112 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009113 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9114 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9115
9116 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9117 backend private_monitoring
9118 stats enable
9119 stats uri /admin?stats
9120 stats refresh 5s
9121
9122 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9123
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009124
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009125stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009126 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009128 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009129
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009130 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009131 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9132
9133 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9134 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9135
9136 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9137 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009138 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009139
9140 Example :
9141 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9142 backend private_monitoring
9143 stats enable
9144 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9145 stats uri /admin?stats
9146 stats refresh 5s
9147
9148 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9149 global section.
9150
9151
9152stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009153 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9155 yes | yes | yes | yes
9156 Arguments : none
9157
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009158 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009159 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9160 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9161 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9162 - IP (socket, server)
9163 - cookie (backend, server)
9164
9165 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9166 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009167 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009168
9169 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9170
9171
9172stats show-node [ <name> ]
9173 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009175 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009176 Arguments:
9177 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9178 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9179
9180 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9181 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009182 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009183
9184 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9185 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9186 unobvious parameters.
9187
9188 Example:
9189 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9190 backend private_monitoring
9191 stats enable
9192 stats show-node Europe-1
9193 stats uri /admin?stats
9194 stats refresh 5s
9195
9196 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9197 section.
9198
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009199
9200stats uri <prefix>
9201 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009203 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009204 Arguments :
9205 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9206 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9207 query string.
9208
9209 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9210 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9211 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9212 possible to reach it in the application.
9213
9214 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009215 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009216 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9217 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9218 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9219 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9220
9221 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9222 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9223 an address or a port to statistics only.
9224
9225 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9226 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9227 unobvious parameters.
9228
9229 Example :
9230 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9231 backend public_www
9232 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9233 stats enable
9234 stats hide-version
9235 stats scope .
9236 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009237 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009238 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9239 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9240
9241 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9242 backend private_monitoring
9243 stats enable
9244 stats uri /admin?stats
9245 stats refresh 5s
9246
9247 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9248
9249
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009250stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9251 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009253 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009254
9255 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009256 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009257 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009258 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009259 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9260
9261 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9262 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9263 the "stick-table" statement.
9264
9265 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9266 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9267 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9268 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9269 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9270
9271 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9272 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9273 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9274 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9275 transformation rules.
9276
9277 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9278 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9279 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9280 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9281 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9282 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9283 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9284
9285 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9286 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9287 ACL based conditions.
9288
9289 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9290 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9291 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9292 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9293
9294 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9295 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9296 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9297 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9298
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009299 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9300 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009301 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009302
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009303 Example :
9304 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9305 # last 30 minutes
9306 backend pop
9307 mode tcp
9308 balance roundrobin
9309 stick store-request src
9310 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9311 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9312 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9313
9314 backend smtp
9315 mode tcp
9316 balance roundrobin
9317 stick match src table pop
9318 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9319 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9320
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009321 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009322 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009323
9324
9325stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9326 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9328 no | no | yes | yes
9329
9330 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9331 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9332 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9333 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9334
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009335 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9336 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009337 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009338
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009339 Examples :
9340 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009341 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009342
9343 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9344 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9345 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9346
9347
9348 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9349 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9350 backend http
9351 mode http
9352 balance roundrobin
9353 stick on src table https
9354 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9355 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9356 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9357
9358 backend https
9359 mode tcp
9360 balance roundrobin
9361 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9362 stick on src
9363 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9364 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9365
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009366 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009367
9368
9369stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9370 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9372 no | no | yes | yes
9373
9374 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009375 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009376 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009377 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009378 server is selected.
9379
9380 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9381 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9382 the "stick-table" statement.
9383
9384 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9385 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9386 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9387 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9388 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9389 address.
9390
9391 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9392 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9393 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9394 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9395 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9396 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9397 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9398 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9399 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9400 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9401
9402 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9403 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9404 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9405 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9406 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9407 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9408 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9409
9410 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9411 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9412 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9413 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9414
9415 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9416 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9417 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9418 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9419 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9420 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009421 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9422 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9423 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9424 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9425 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9426 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009427
9428 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9429 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9430 the request.
9431
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009432 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9433 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009434 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009435
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009436 Example :
9437 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9438 # last 30 minutes
9439 backend pop
9440 mode tcp
9441 balance roundrobin
9442 stick store-request src
9443 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9444 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9445 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9446
9447 backend smtp
9448 mode tcp
9449 balance roundrobin
9450 stick match src table pop
9451 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9452 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9453
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009454 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009455 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009456
9457
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009458stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009459 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9460 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009461 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009463 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009464
9465 Arguments :
9466 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9467 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9468 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9469 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9470
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009471 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9472 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9473 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9474 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9475
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009476 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9477 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9478 instance.
9479
9480 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9481 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9482 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9483 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9484 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9485 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009486 to 32 characters.
9487
9488 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9489 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9490 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009491 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009492 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9493 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009494
9495 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009496 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9497 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009498 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9499 increase.
9500
9501 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009502 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9503 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9504 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009505
9506 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9507 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9508 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9509 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009510 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009511 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9512 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9513 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9514 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9515 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9516 parameter (see below).
9517
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009518 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9519 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9520 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9521 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9522 soft restart.
9523
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009524 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9525 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009526
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009527 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9528 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9529 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9530 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009531 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009532 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009533 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9534 if not expiration delay is specified.
9535
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009536 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9537 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9538 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9539 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009540 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9541 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9542 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9543 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9544 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9545 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9546 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9547 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9548 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9549 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9550 types and their arguments.
9551
9552 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9553 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9554 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9555 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9556
9557 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9558 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9559 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009560 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009561
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009562 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9563 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9564 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009565 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009566 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009567 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009568
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009569 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9570 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9571 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9572 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9573
9574 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9575 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9576 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9577 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9578 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9579 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9580
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009581 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9582 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9583 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9584 they were received.
9585
9586 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9587 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9588 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9589 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9590 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9591
9592 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9593 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9594 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9595 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9596 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9597
9598 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9599 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9600 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9601
9602 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9603 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9604 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9605 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9606 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9607
9608 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9609 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9610 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9611 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9612 the client side.
9613
9614 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9615 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9616 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9617 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9618 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9619 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9620 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9621
9622 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9623 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9624 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9625 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9626 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9627 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009628 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009629
9630 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9631 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9632 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9633 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9634 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9635 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9636
9637 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009638 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009639 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9640 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9641
9642 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9643 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9644 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9645 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9646 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9647 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9648 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9649 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9650 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9651 recommended for better fairness.
9652
9653 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009654 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009655 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9656 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9657
9658 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9659 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9660 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9661 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9662 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9663 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9664 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9665 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9666 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9667 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009668
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009669 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9670 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009671 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9672 reference it.
9673
9674 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9675 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009676 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9677 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9678 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009679
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009680 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9681 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9682 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9683 something that can be ignored.
9684
9685 Example:
9686 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9687 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9688 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9689 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9690
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009691 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009692 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009693
9694
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009695stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009696 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9698 no | no | yes | yes
9699
9700 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009701 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009702 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009703 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009704 server is selected.
9705
9706 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9707 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9708 the "stick-table" statement.
9709
9710 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9711 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9712 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9713 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9714
9715 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9716 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9717 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9718 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9719 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9720 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009721 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009722 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9723 rules.
9724
9725 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9726 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9727 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9728 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9729 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9730 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9731 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9732
9733 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9734 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9735 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9736 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9737
9738 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9739 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9740 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9741 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9742 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9743 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009744 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9745 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9746 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9747 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9748 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9749 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9750 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9751 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9752 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009753
9754 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9755
9756 Example :
9757 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9758 backend https
9759 mode tcp
9760 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009761 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009762 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009763
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009764 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9765 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9766
9767 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9768 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9769 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9770
9771 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9772 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009773
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009774 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9775 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9776 # at offset 44.
9777
9778 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9779 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9780
9781 # Learn on response if server hello.
9782 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009783
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009784 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9785 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9786
9787 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9788 extraction.
9789
9790
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009791tcp-check connect [params*]
9792 Opens a new connection
9793 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9794 no | no | yes | yes
9795
9796 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9797 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9798 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9799
9800 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9801 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9802 of the sequence.
9803
9804 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9805 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9806 do.
9807
9808 Parameters :
9809 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9810 use the TCP connection.
9811
9812 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9813 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9814 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9815
9816 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9817
9818 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9819
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009820 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
9821
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009822 Examples:
9823 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9824 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9825 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9826 option tcp-check
9827 tcp-check connect
9828 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9829 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9830 tcp-check send \r\n
9831 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9832 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9833 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9834 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9835 tcp-check send \r\n
9836 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9837 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9838
9839 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9840 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009841 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009842 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9843 tcp-check connect port 143
9844 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9845 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9846
9847 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9848
9849
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009850tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009851 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009852 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9853 no | no | yes | yes
9854
9855 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009856 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
9857 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
9858 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
9859 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
9860 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
9861 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
9862 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
9863 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
9864 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
9865 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
9866
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009867 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009868 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
9869 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009870 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9871 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9872 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9873
9874 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9875 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9876 with the usual backslash ('\').
9877 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009878 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009879 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9880 used upper or lower case.
9881
9882
9883 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9884
9885 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9886 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9887 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9888 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9889 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9890 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9891 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9892 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9893
9894 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9895 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9896 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9897 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9898 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9899 expression.
9900
9901 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9902 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9903 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9904 this exact hexadecimal string.
9905 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9906
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009907 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
9908 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
9909 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
9910 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
9911 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
9912 size of the original response. As such, the expected
9913 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
9914 size.
9915
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009916 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9917 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9918 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9919 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9920 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9921 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9922 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9923 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9924 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9925 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9926 the null character.
9927
9928 Examples :
9929 # perform a POP check
9930 option tcp-check
9931 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9932
9933 # perform an IMAP check
9934 option tcp-check
9935 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9936
9937 # look for the redis master server
9938 option tcp-check
9939 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009940 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009941 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9942 tcp-check expect string role:master
9943 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9944 tcp-check expect string +OK
9945
9946
9947 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9948 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9949
9950
9951tcp-check send <data>
9952 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9953 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9954 no | no | yes | yes
9955
9956 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9957 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9958
9959 Examples :
9960 # look for the redis master server
9961 option tcp-check
9962 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9963 tcp-check expect string role:master
9964
9965 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9966 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9967
9968
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009969tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9970 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009971 tcp health check
9972 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9973 no | no | yes | yes
9974
9975 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9976 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009977 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009978 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9979 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9980 hexadecimal string.
9981 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9982
9983 Examples :
9984 # redis check in binary
9985 option tcp-check
9986 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9987 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9988
9989
9990 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9991 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9992
9993
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009994tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9995 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9997 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009998 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009999 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10000 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010001
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010002 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010003
10004 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10005 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010006 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10007 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10008 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10009 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10010 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10011 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010012
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010013 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10014 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10015 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10016 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010017
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010018 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010019 - accept :
10020 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10021 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10022 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010023
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010024 - reject :
10025 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10026 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10027 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10028 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10029 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10030 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10031 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10032 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10033 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10034 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10035 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010036 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010037
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010038 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10039 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10040 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10041 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10042 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10043 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10044 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10045 hosts.
10046
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010047 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10048 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10049 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10050 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10051 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10052 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10053 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10054 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10055
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010056 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10057 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10058 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10059 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10060 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10061 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10062 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10063 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10064 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010065 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10066 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010067
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010068 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010069 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010070 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10071 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10072 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010073 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010074 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10075 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10076 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10077 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10078 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10079 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10080 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10081 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010083 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010084 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010085 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010086 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010087 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10088 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10089 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010091 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10092 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10093 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10094 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010095
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010096 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10097 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10098 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10099 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10100 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010101 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10102 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10103 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10104 layer7 information is extracted.
10105
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010106 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10107 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10108 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10109 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10110 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010111
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010112 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10113 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10114 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10115 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10116
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010117 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10118 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10119 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10120 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10121
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010122 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10123 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10124 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10125 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10126 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010127
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010128 - set-src <expr> :
10129 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10130 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10131 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010132 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010133
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010134 Arguments:
10135 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10136 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010137
10138 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010139 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10140
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010141 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10142 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010143
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010144 - set-src-port <expr> :
10145 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10146 expression.
10147
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010148 Arguments:
10149 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10150 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010151
10152 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010153 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10154
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010155 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10156 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10157 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010158
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010159 - set-dst <expr> :
10160 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10161 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10162 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10163 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10164 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10165
10166 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10167 followed by some converters.
10168
10169 Example:
10170
10171 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10172 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10173
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010174 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10175 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10176
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010177 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10178 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10179 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10180 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10181
10182
10183 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10184 followed by some converters.
10185
10186 Example:
10187
10188 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10189
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010190 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10191 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10192 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10193
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010194 - "silent-drop" :
10195 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010196 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010197 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10198 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10199 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10200 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10201 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010202 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10203 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010204 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10205 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010206 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010207 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10208 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10209 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10210 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10211
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010212 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10213 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10214 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010215
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010216 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10217 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10218 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010219
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010220 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010221 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010222 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010223
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010224 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10225 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10226 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010227
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010228 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010229 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10230 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010231
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010232 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10233
10234 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10235
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010236 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10237
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010238 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010239
10240
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010241tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10242 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010244 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010245 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010246 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10247 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010248
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010249 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010250
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010251 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010252 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10253 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10254 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10255 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010256
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010257 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10258 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10259 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10260 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010261 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10262 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10263 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10264 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10265 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10266 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010267 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010268 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010269
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010270 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10271 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10272 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10273 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010274
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010275 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010276 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010277 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010278 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10279 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010280 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010281 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010282 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010283 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010284 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010285 - set-dst <expr>
10286 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010287 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010288 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010289 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010290 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010291 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010292
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010293 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10294 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010295 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10296 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010297
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010298 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10299 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10300 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10301 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10302 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10303 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010304
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010305 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010306 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10307 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010308
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010309 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010310 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10311 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10312 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10313 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010314 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10315 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10316 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010317
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010318 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010319 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10320 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10321 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010322
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010323 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10324 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10325
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010326 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010327 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10328 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010329
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010330 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10331 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010332 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010333 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10334 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010335 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010336 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010337 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010338 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10339 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010340 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010341 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10342 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010343
10344 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10345 followed by some converters.
10346
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010347 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10348 <var-name>.
10349
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010350 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10351 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10352 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10353 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10354 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10355
10356 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10357 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10358 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10359 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10360 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10361 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10362 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10363 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10364 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10365 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10366 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10367
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010368 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10369 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10370 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10371 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10372 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10373
10374 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10375
10376 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10377
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010378 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10379 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10380 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10381 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10382 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10383 evaluated.
10384
10385 Example:
10386 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10387
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010388 Example:
10389
10390 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010391 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010392
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010393 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010394 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10395 # and reject everything else.
10396 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10397 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010398 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010399 tcp-request content reject
10400
10401 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010402 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10403 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10404 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010405 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010406
10407 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10408 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10409 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010410 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010411 tcp-request content reject
10412
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010413 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010414 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010415 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010416 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010417 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10418 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010419
10420 Example:
10421 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10422 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010423 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010424
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010425 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010426 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010427
10428 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010429 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010430 # protecting all our sites
10431 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010432 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10433 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010434 ...
10435 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10436
10437 backend http_dynamic
10438 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010439 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010440 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010441 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010442 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010443 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010444 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010445
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010446 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010447
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010448 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10449 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010450
10451
10452tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10453 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010455 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010456 Arguments :
10457 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10458 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10459 as explained at the top of this document.
10460
10461 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10462 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10463 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10464 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10465 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10466
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010467 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10468 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10469 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10470 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10471
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010472 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10473 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010474 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010475 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010476 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10477 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10478 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10479 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010480
10481 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10482 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10483 it pass through unaffected.
10484
10485 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10486 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10487 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010488 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010489 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10490 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010491 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10492 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10493 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010494
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010495 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010496 "timeout client".
10497
10498
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010499tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10500 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10502 no | no | yes | yes
10503 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010504 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10505 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010506
10507 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10508
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010509 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010510 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10511 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010512 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10513 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010514
10515 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10516
10517 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10518 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10519 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10520 inserted.
10521
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010522 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010523 - accept :
10524 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10525 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10526 the rules evaluation.
10527
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010528 - close :
10529 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10530 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10531 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10532 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10533 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10534 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010535 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010536 protocols.
10537
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010538 - reject :
10539 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10540 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010541 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010542
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010543 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10544 Sets a variable.
10545
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010546 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10547 Unsets a variable.
10548
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010549 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10550 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10551 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10552 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10553
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010554 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10555 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10556 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10557 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10558
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010559 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10560 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10561 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10562 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10563 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010564
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010565 - "silent-drop" :
10566 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010567 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010568 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10569 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10570 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10571 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10572 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010573 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10574 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010575 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10576 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010577 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010578 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10579 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10580 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10581 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10582
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010583 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10584 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10585
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010586 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10587 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10588 for changing the default action to a reject.
10589
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010590 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10591 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10592 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10593 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010594 period.
10595
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010596 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10597 declared inline.
10598
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010599 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10600 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010601 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010602 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10603 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010604 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010605 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010606 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010607 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10608 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010609 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010610 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10611 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010612
10613 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10614 followed by some converters.
10615
10616 Example:
10617
10618 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10619
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010620 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10621 <var-name>.
10622
10623 Example:
10624
10625 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10626
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010627 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10628 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10629 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10630 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10631 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10632
10633 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10634
10635 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10636
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010637 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10638
10639 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10640
10641
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010642tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10643 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10645 no | yes | yes | no
10646 Arguments :
10647 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10648 below.
10649
10650 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10651
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010652 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010653 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10654 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10655 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10656 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10657 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10658 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10659 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010660 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010661 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10662 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10663 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10664 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10665 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10666 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10667 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10668 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10669 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10670 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10671 instead.
10672
10673 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10674 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10675 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10676 rules which may be inserted.
10677
10678 Several types of actions are supported :
10679 - accept : the request is accepted
10680 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10681 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10682 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010683 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010684 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010685 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010686 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010687 - silent-drop
10688
10689 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10690 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10691 sections for a complete description.
10692
10693 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10694 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10695 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10696
10697 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10698 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10699 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10700 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10701 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10702
10703 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10704 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10705
10706 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10707 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10708 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10709
10710 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10711 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10712 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10713
10714 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10715 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10716 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10717
10718 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10719 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10720 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10721
10722 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10723
10724 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10725
10726
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010727tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10728 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10730 no | no | yes | yes
10731 Arguments :
10732 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10733 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10734 as explained at the top of this document.
10735
10736 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10737
10738
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010739timeout check <timeout>
10740 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10741 established.
10742
10743 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10744 yes | no | yes | yes
10745 Arguments:
10746 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10747 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10748 as explained at the top of this document.
10749
10750 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10751 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010752 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010753 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010754 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10755 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10756 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010757
10758 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10759 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10760
10761 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10762 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010763 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010764
10765 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10766 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10767 forget about it.
10768
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010769 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10770 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010771
10772
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010773timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010774 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10776 yes | yes | yes | no
10777 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010778 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010779 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10780 as explained at the top of this document.
10781
10782 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10783 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10784 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010785 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10786 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10787 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10788 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010789 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10790 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10791 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010792 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010793 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010794 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10795 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010796 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10797 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010798
10799 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10800 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10801 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10802 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010803 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010804 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10805
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010806 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010807
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010808 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010809
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010810
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010811timeout client-fin <timeout>
10812 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10814 yes | yes | yes | no
10815 Arguments :
10816 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10817 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10818 as explained at the top of this document.
10819
10820 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10821 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10822 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10823 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10824 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10825 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10826 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010827 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10828 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10829 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010830
10831 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10832 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10833 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10834
10835 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10836
10837
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010838timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010839 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10841 yes | no | yes | yes
10842 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010843 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010844 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10845 as explained at the top of this document.
10846
10847 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010848 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010849 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010850 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010851 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10852 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010853
10854 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10855 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10856 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10857 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010858 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010859 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10860
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010861 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010862
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010863
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010864timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10865 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10867 yes | yes | yes | yes
10868 Arguments :
10869 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10870 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10871 as explained at the top of this document.
10872
10873 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10874 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10875 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10876 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10877 once the request has started to present itself.
10878
10879 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10880 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10881 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10882 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10883 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10884
10885 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10886 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10887 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10888 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10889
10890 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10891 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010892 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010893 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10894 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010895 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010896
10897 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10898 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10899 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10900 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10901
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010902 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10903 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010904 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10905
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010906 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10907
10908
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010909timeout http-request <timeout>
10910 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010912 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010913 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010914 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010915 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10916 as explained at the top of this document.
10917
10918 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10919 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10920 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10921 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10922 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10923 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10924 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010925 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10926 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10927 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10928 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010929 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010930 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10931 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010932
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010933 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10934 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10935 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10936 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10937 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010938 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010939
10940 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10941 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010942 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010943 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10944 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10945
10946 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010947 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10948 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10949 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010950
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010951 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010952 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010953
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010954
10955timeout queue <timeout>
10956 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10958 yes | no | yes | yes
10959 Arguments :
10960 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10961 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10962 as explained at the top of this document.
10963
10964 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10965 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10966 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10967 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10968 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10969
10970 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10971 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10972 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10973 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10974
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010975 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010976
10977
10978timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010979 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10981 yes | no | yes | yes
10982 Arguments :
10983 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10984 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10985 as explained at the top of this document.
10986
10987 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10988 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10989 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10990 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10991 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10992 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10993 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10994
10995 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10996 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10997 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10998 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10999 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011000 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011001 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011002 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11003 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011004 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11005 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011006
11007 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11008 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11009 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11010 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011011 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011012 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11013
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011014 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011015
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011016
11017timeout server-fin <timeout>
11018 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11020 yes | no | yes | yes
11021 Arguments :
11022 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11023 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11024 as explained at the top of this document.
11025
11026 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11027 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11028 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11029 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11030 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11031 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11032 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11033 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11034 situations, it should not be needed.
11035
11036 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11037 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11038 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11039
11040 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11041
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011042
11043timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011044 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11046 yes | yes | yes | yes
11047 Arguments :
11048 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11049 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11050 as explained at the top of this document.
11051
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011052 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11053 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11054 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011055
11056 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11057 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11058 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11059 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011060 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011061
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011062 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011063
11064
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011065timeout tunnel <timeout>
11066 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11068 yes | no | yes | yes
11069 Arguments :
11070 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11071 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11072 as explained at the top of this document.
11073
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011074 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011075 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11076 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11077 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011078 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11079 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011080 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11081 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11082 specified.
11083
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011084 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11085 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11086 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11087 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11088 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11089 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11090 state.
11091
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011092 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11093 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11094 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11095 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011096 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011097
11098 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11099 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11100 forget about it.
11101
11102 Example :
11103 defaults http
11104 option http-server-close
11105 timeout connect 5s
11106 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011107 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011108 timeout server 30s
11109 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11110
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011111 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011112
11113
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011114transparent (deprecated)
11115 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011117 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011118 Arguments : none
11119
11120 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11121 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11122 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11123 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11124 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11125 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11126 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11127 appropriate server.
11128
11129 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11130
11131 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11132 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11133
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011134 See also: "option transparent"
11135
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011136unique-id-format <string>
11137 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11139 yes | yes | yes | no
11140 Arguments :
11141 <string> is a log-format string.
11142
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011143 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11144 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11145 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11146 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011147
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011148 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11149 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11150 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11151 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11152 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11153 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11154 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11155 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011156
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011157 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11158 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011159
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011160 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011161
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011162 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011163
11164 will generate:
11165
11166 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11167
11168 See also: "unique-id-header"
11169
11170unique-id-header <name>
11171 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11173 yes | yes | yes | no
11174 Arguments :
11175 <name> is the name of the header.
11176
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011177 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11178 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011179
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011180 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011181
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011182 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011183 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11184
11185 will generate:
11186
11187 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11188
11189 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011190
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011191use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011192 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11194 no | yes | yes | no
11195 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011196 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11197 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011198
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011199 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11200 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011201
11202 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11203 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11204 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011205 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011206 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011207 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11208 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011209
11210 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11211 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11212 assign the backend.
11213
11214 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11215 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11216 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11217 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11218 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11219 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11220
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011221 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011222 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011223 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11224 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11225 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11226
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011227 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11228 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11229 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11230 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11231 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11232 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11233 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11234 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11235 cannot be forced from the request.
11236
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011237 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011238 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11239 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11240
11241 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11242 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011243
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011244use-fcgi-app <name>
11245 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11247 no | no | yes | yes
11248 Arguments :
11249 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11250
11251 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011252
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011253use-server <server> if <condition>
11254use-server <server> unless <condition>
11255 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11257 no | no | yes | yes
11258 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011259 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11260 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011261
11262 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11263
11264 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11265 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11266 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11267
11268 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11269 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11270 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11271 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11272 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11273 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11274 matches will assign the server.
11275
11276 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11277 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11278 with the next rules until one matches.
11279
11280 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11281 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11282 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11283 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11284
11285 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11286 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11287 stripped.
11288
11289 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11290 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11291 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11292 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11293
11294 Example :
11295 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11296 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11297 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11298 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11299 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11300 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011301 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011302 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11303 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11304
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011305 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11306 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11307 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11308 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11309 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11310 and we fall back to load balancing.
11311
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011312 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011313
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011314
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100113155. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011316--------------------------
11317
11318The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11319depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11320settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11321written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11322described in this section.
11323
11324
113255.1. Bind options
11326-----------------
11327
11328The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11329as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11330no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11331parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11332while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11333provided immediately after the setting name.
11334
11335The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11336
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011337accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11338 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11339 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11340 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11341 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11342 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11343 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11344 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11345 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11346 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011347 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11348 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11349 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011350
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011351accept-proxy
11352 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011353 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11354 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011355 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11356 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11357 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11358 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011359 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011360 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11361 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011362 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11363 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011364
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011365allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011366 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011367 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011368 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011369 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11370 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011371
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011372alpn <protocols>
11373 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11374 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11375 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011376 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011377 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011378 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11379 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11380 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11381 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11382 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11383 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11384 preference, like below :
11385
11386 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011387
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011388backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011389 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011390 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11391
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011392curves <curves>
11393 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11394 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11395 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11396 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11397 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11398 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11399
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011400ecdhe <named curve>
11401 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011402 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11403 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011404
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011405ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011406 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11407 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11408 client's certificate.
11409
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011410ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11411 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11412 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11413 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11414 error is ignored.
11415
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011416ca-sign-file <cafile>
11417 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11418 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11419 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11420 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11421 'generate-certificates' for details.
11422
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011423ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011424 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11425 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11426 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11427 'generate-certificates' for details.
11428
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011429ca-verify-file <cafile>
11430 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
11431 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
11432 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
11433 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
11434 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
11435
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011436ciphers <ciphers>
11437 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11438 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011439 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011440 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011441 information and recommendations see e.g.
11442 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11443 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11444 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11445
11446ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11447 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11448 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11449 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11450 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011451 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11452 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011453
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011454crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011455 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11456 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11457 to verify client's certificate.
11458
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011459crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011460 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11461 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11462 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11463 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11464 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011465 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11466 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011467
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010011468 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
11469 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
11470
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011471 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11472 are loaded.
11473
11474 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010011475 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
11476 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
11477 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
11478 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
11479 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
11480 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
11481 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011482 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011483
11484 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11485 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11486 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11487 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011488 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11489 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011490
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011491 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011492
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011493 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011494 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011495 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11496 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011497 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11498 clients).
11499
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011500 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11501 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11502 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11503 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11504 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11505 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11506 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11507 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11508 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11509 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11510 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11511 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11512 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11513
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011514 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11515 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11516 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11517 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11518 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11519
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011520 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11521 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11522 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11523 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011524
11525 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11526 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11527 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11528 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11529 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11530 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11531 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11532 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11533 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11534
11535 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11536
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011537 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011538 a cert bundle.
11539
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011540 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011541 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11542 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11543 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11544 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11545 provide multi-cert support.
11546
11547 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11548
11549 Filename | CN | SAN
11550 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11551 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011552 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011553 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11554 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11555
11556 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11557 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11558 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11559 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011560 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11561 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11562 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011563
11564 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11565 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11566
11567 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11568 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11569 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11570
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011571crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011572 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011573 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011574 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011575 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011576
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011577crt-list <file>
11578 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011579 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11580 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011581
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011582 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11583
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011584 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
11585 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
11586 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
11587 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011588
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011589 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11590 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11591 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11592 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11593 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11594 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11595 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11596 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011597
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011598 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011599 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011600 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11601 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11602 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011603
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011604 crt-list file example:
11605 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011606 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011607 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011608 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011609
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011610defer-accept
11611 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11612 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11613 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011614 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011615 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11616 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11617 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11618 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11619 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11620 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11621 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11622
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011623expose-fd listeners
11624 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11625 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011626 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11627 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011628 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011629
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011630force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011631 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011632 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011633 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011634 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011635
11636force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011637 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011638 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011639 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011640
11641force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011642 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011643 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011644 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011645
11646force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011647 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011648 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011649 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011650
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011651force-tlsv13
11652 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11653 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011654 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011655
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011656generate-certificates
11657 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11658 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11659 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11660 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11661 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11662 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11663 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11664 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11665 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11666 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11667 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11668
11669 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11670 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011671 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011672 certificate is used many times.
11673
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011674gid <gid>
11675 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11676 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11677 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11678 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11679 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11680
11681group <group>
11682 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11683 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11684 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11685 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11686 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11687
11688id <id>
11689 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11690 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11691 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11692 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11693
11694interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011695 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11696 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11697 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11698 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11699 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11700 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011701 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11702 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11703 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11704 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11705 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11706 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011707
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011708level <level>
11709 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11710 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11711 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011712 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011713 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11714 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11715 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011716 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011717 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011718 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011719 all counters).
11720
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011721severity-output <format>
11722 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11723 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11724 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11725 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11726 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11727 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11728 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11729 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11730 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11731 rfc5424 convention.
11732
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011733maxconn <maxconn>
11734 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11735 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11736 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11737 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11738 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11739 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11740 eat all memory.
11741
11742mode <mode>
11743 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11744 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11745 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11746 UNIX sockets.
11747
11748mss <maxseg>
11749 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11750 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11751 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11752 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11753 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11754 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11755 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11756 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11757 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11758 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11759 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11760
11761name <name>
11762 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11763 page.
11764
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011765namespace <name>
11766 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11767 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11768 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11769 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11770
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011771nice <nice>
11772 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11773 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11774 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11775 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11776 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11777 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11778 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11779 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11780 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11781 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11782 one for an RDP socket.
11783
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011784no-ca-names
11785 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11786 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011787 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011788
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011789no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011790 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011791 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011792 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011793 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011794 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11795 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011796
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011797no-tls-tickets
11798 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11799 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11800 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011801 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11802 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011803 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11804 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11805 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011806
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011807no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011809 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011810 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011811 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011812 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11813 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011814
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011815no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011816 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011817 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011818 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011819 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011820 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11821 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011822
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011823no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011824 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011825 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011826 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011827 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011828 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11829 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011830
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011831no-tlsv13
11832 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11833 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11834 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11835 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011836 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11837 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011838
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011839npn <protocols>
11840 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11841 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11842 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011843 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011844 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011845 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11846 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11847 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11848 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11849 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011850
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011851prefer-client-ciphers
11852 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11853 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11854 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011855 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11856 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11857 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011858
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011859process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011860 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011861 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011862 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011863 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11864 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11865 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11866 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011867 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011868 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11869 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11870 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11871 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11872 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011873
11874 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11875
11876 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11877 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11878 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11879 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11880 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11881 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11882 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11883 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011884
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011885proto <name>
11886 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11887 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11888 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11889 in haproxy -vv.
11890 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11891 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011892 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011893 h2" on the bind line.
11894
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011895ssl
11896 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011897 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011898 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11899 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011900 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11901 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011902
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011903ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11904 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11905 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11906 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11907
11908ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11909 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11910 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11911 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11912
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011913strict-sni
11914 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11915 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11916 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11917 See the "crt" option for more information.
11918
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011919tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011920 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011921 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11922 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011923 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011924 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11925 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11926 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11927 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11928 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11929 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11930 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11931
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011932tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011933 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011934 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11935 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11936 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11937 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11938 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11939 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11940 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011941 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11942 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11943 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011944
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011945tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11946 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011947 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11948 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11949 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11950 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11951 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11952 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11953 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11954 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11955 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11956 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011957 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11958 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11959
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011960transparent
11961 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11962 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11963 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11964 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11965 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11966 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11967 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11968 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11969 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11970 so check for support with your vendor.
11971
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011972v4v6
11973 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11974 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11975 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11976 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011977 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011978
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011979v6only
11980 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11981 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11982 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011983 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11984 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011985
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011986uid <uid>
11987 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11988 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11989 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11990 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11991 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11992
11993user <user>
11994 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11995 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11996 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11997 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11998 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11999
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012000verify [none|optional|required]
12001 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12002 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12003 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12004 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12005 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012006 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12007 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12008 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12009 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012010
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200120115.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012012------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012014The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12015which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12016arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12017settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12018after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12019Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12020address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012022 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012023 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012024
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012025Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12026keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12027
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012028The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012029
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012030addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012031 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012032 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12033 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12034 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12035 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12036 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012037
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012038agent-check
12039 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012040 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012041 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12042 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12043 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012044
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012045 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012046 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012047 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12048 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12049 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012050
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012051 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12052 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12053 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12054 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12055 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012056
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012057 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012058 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012059
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012060 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12061 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12062 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012063
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012064 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12065 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12066 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012067
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012068 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12069 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12070 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12071 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12072 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012073 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012074 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012075
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012076 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12077 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012078
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012079 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12080 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12081 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12082 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12083 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12084 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12085 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12086 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12087 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012088
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012089 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12090 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012091 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12092 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12093 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012094 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012095
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012096 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012097 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012098
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012099agent-send <string>
12100 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12101 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12102 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12103 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12104 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12105
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012106agent-inter <delay>
12107 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12108 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12109
12110 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12111 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12112 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12113 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12114 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12115 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12116 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12117 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12118 of backends use the same servers.
12119
12120 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12121
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012122agent-addr <addr>
12123 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12124
12125 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12126 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12127 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12128 hostname, it will be resolved.
12129
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012130agent-port <port>
12131 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12132
12133 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12134
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012135allow-0rtt
12136 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012137 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12138 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012139
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012140alpn <protocols>
12141 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12142 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12143 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012144 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012145 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12146 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12147 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12148 now obsolete NPN extension.
12149 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12150 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12151
12152 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12153
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012154backup
12155 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12156 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12157 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12158 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012159 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12160 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012161
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012162ca-file <cafile>
12163 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12164 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12165 server's certificate.
12166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012167check
12168 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012169 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12170 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12171 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12172 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12173 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12174 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12175 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012176 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12177 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012178 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12179 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012180
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012181check-send-proxy
12182 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12183 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12184 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12185 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12186 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12187 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12188 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12189
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012190check-alpn <protocols>
12191 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12192 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12193 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12194
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012195check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012196 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012197 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12198 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012199
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012200check-ssl
12201 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12202 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12203 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12204 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012205 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012206 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12207 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012208 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012209 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12210 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012211
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012212check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012213 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012214 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12215 for normal traffic.
12216
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012217ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012218 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12219 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12220 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012221 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12222 information and recommendations see e.g.
12223 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12224 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12225 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012226
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012227ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12228 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12229 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12230 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12231 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012232 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12233 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12234 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012235
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012236cookie <value>
12237 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12238 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12239 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12240 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12241 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12242 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12243 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12244
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012245crl-file <crlfile>
12246 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12247 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12248 to verify server's certificate.
12249
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012250crt <cert>
12251 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12252 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12253 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12254 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12255 certificate request.
12256
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012257disabled
12258 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12259 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12260 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12261 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12262 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012263 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012264
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012265enabled
12266 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12267 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12268 default value.
12269 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12270 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012271
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012272error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012273 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12274 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12275 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012276
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012277 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012278
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012279fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012280 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12281 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12282 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12283
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012284force-sslv3
12285 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12286 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012287 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012288 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012289
12290force-tlsv10
12291 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012292 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012293 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012294
12295force-tlsv11
12296 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012297 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012298 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012299
12300force-tlsv12
12301 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012302 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012303 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012304
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012305force-tlsv13
12306 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12307 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012308 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012310id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012311 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12312 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12313 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012314
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012315init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12316 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12317 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012318 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012319 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12320 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12321 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12322 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12323 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12324 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12325 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12326 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12327 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012328 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012329 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12330 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12331 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12332 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12333 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12334 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012335 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012336
12337 Example:
12338 defaults
12339 # never fail on address resolution
12340 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012342inter <delay>
12343fastinter <delay>
12344downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012345 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12346 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12347 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12348 between checks depending on the server state :
12349
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012350 Server state | Interval used
12351 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12352 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12353 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12354 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12355 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12356 or yet unchecked. |
12357 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12358 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12359 | "inter" otherwise.
12360 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012362 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12363 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12364 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12365 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012366 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12367 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12368 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12369 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12370 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012371
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012372maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012373 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12374 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012375 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12376 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012377 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12378 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12379 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12380 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12381
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012382 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12383 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12384 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12385 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12386 than 50 concurrent requests.
12387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012388maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012389 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12390 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12391 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12392 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12393 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12394 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12395 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12396
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012397max-reuse <count>
12398 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12399 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12400 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12401 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12402 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12403 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12404 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12405 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012407minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012408 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12409 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12410 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12411 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12412 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12413 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012414 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012415 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012416
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012417namespace <name>
12418 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12419 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12420 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12421 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12422
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012423no-agent-check
12424 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12425 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12426 default value.
12427 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12428 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12429
12430no-backup
12431 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12432 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12433 default value.
12434 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12435 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12436
12437no-check
12438 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12439 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12440 default value.
12441 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12442 "default-server" "check" setting.
12443
12444no-check-ssl
12445 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12446 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12447 default value.
12448 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12449 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12450
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012451no-send-proxy
12452 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12453 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12454 default value.
12455 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12456 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12457
12458no-send-proxy-v2
12459 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12460 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12461 default value.
12462 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12463 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12464
12465no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12466 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12467 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12468 default value.
12469 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12470 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12471
12472no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12473 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12474 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12475 default value.
12476 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12477 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12478
12479no-ssl
12480 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12481 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12482 default value.
12483 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12484 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12485
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012486no-ssl-reuse
12487 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12488 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12489 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12490 and for paranoid users.
12491
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012492no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012493 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12494 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012495 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012496
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012497 Supported in default-server: No
12498
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012499no-tls-tickets
12500 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12501 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12502 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012503 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12504 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012505 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12506 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12507 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012508 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012509
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012510no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012511 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012512 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12513 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012514 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12515 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012516 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012517
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012518 Supported in default-server: No
12519
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012520no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012521 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012522 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12523 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012524 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12525 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012526 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012527
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012528 Supported in default-server: No
12529
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012530no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012531 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012532 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12533 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012534 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12535 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012536 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012537
12538 Supported in default-server: No
12539
12540no-tlsv13
12541 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12542 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12543 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12544 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12545 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012546 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012547
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012548 Supported in default-server: No
12549
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012550no-verifyhost
12551 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12552 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12553 default value.
12554 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12555 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012556
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012557no-tfo
12558 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12559 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12560 default value.
12561 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12562 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12563
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012564non-stick
12565 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12566 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12567 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12568
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012569npn <protocols>
12570 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12571 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12572 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012573 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012574 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12575 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12576 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12577
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012578observe <mode>
12579 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12580 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12581 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12582 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12583 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12584 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012585 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012586
12587 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012589on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012590 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12591 Currently, four modes are available:
12592 - fastinter: force fastinter
12593 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12594 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12595 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12596 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12597
12598 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12599
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012600on-marked-down <action>
12601 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12602 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012603 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12604 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12605 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12606 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12607 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12608 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12609 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12610 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012611
12612 Actions are disabled by default
12613
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012614on-marked-up <action>
12615 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12616 Currently one action is available:
12617 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12618 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12619 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12620 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012621 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12622 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012623 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12624 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12625
12626 Actions are disabled by default
12627
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012628pool-max-conn <max>
12629 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12630 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12631 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12632 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12633 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12634 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12635
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012636pool-purge-delay <delay>
12637 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012638 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012639 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012640
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012641port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012642 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12643 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12644 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12645 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12646 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12647 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12648
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012649proto <name>
12650
12651 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12652 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12653 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12654 reported in haproxy -vv.
12655 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12656 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012658redir <prefix>
12659 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12660 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12661 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12662 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12663 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12664 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12665 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12666 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012667 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012668 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012669 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12670 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12671 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12672 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12673
12674 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12675
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012676rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012677 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12678 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12679 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12680
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012681resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12682 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12683 server.
12684
12685 Available options:
12686
12687 * allow-dup-ip
12688 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12689 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12690 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12691 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12692 For such case, simply enable this option.
12693 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12694
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012695 * ignore-weight
12696 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12697 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12698 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12699
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012700 * prevent-dup-ip
12701 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12702 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12703 same fqdn.
12704 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12705
12706 Example:
12707 backend b_myapp
12708 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12709 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12710 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12711
12712 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12713 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12714 it
12715 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12716 different address
12717
12718 Default value: not set
12719
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012720resolve-prefer <family>
12721 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12722 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12723 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12724 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12725
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012726 Default value: ipv6
12727
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012728 Example:
12729
12730 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012731
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012732resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012733 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012734 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012735 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012736 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12737 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012738 configured network, another address is selected.
12739
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012740 Example:
12741
12742 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012743
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012744resolvers <id>
12745 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12746 hostname.
12747
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012748 Example:
12749
12750 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012751
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012752 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012753
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012754send-proxy
12755 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12756 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12757 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12758 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012759 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12760 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12761 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12762 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12763 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12764 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12765 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12766 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12767 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12768 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012769 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12770 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012771
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012772send-proxy-v2
12773 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12774 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12775 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12776 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012777 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12778 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12779 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12780 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012781
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012782proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010012783 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
12784 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
12785
12786 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
12787 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
12788 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
12789 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
12790 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
12791 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
12792 connection is supported).
12793 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
12794 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
12795 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
12796 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
12797 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
12798 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
12799 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012800
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012801send-proxy-v2-ssl
12802 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12803 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12804 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12805 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12806 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12807 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12808 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012809 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12810 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012811
12812send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12813 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12814 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12815 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12816 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12817 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12818 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12819 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12820 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012821 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12822 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012823
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012824slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012825 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12826 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12827 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12828 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12829 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12830 parameters :
12831
12832 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12833 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12834
12835 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12836 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12837 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12838 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12839
12840 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12841 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12842 seen as failed.
12843
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012844sni <expression>
12845 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12846 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12847 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12848 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012849 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12850 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012851 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012852 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12853 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012854
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012855source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012856source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012857source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012858 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12859 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12860 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12861 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12862
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012863 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12864 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12865 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12866 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12867 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12868 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12869 server.
12870
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012871 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12872 specifying the source address without port(s).
12873
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012874ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012875 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12876 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12877 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12878 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12879 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12880 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012881 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12882 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012883
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012884ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12885 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12886 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12887 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12888
12889ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12890 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12891 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12892 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12893
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012894ssl-reuse
12895 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12896 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12897 default value.
12898 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12899 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12900
12901stick
12902 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12903 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12904 default value.
12905 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12906 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012907
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012908socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012909 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012910 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12911 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12912
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012913tcp-ut <delay>
12914 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12915 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12916 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012917 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012918 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12919 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12920 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12921 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12922 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12923 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12924 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12925 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12926 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12927
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012928tfo
12929 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12930 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12931 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12932 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12933 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012934 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012936track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012937 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12938 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12939 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12940 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012941 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12942
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012943tls-tickets
12944 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12945 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12946 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012947 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12948 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12949 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012950 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010012951 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012952
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012953verify [none|required]
12954 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012955 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012956 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12957 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012958 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012959 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12960 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12961 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12962 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12963 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12964 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12965 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12966 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012967
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012968verifyhost <hostname>
12969 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012970 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12971 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12972 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12973 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12974 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12975 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12976 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12977 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012978
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012979weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012980 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12981 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12982 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012983 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12984 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12985 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12986 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12987 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12988 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012989
12990
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129915.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12992-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012993
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012994HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12995using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12996configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012997This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12998can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12999workload.
13000This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13001resolution at run time.
13002Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13003carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13004
13005
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130065.3.1. Global overview
13007----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013008
13009As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13010different steps of the process life:
13011
13012 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13013 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13014 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13015
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013016 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13017 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013018
13019A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13020 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13021 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13022 resolution to know this new IP.
13023
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013024When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013025HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013026SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13027from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13028will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13029will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013030
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013031A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013032 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013033 first valid response.
13034
13035 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13036 servers return an error.
13037
13038
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130395.3.2. The resolvers section
13040----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013041
13042This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013043HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13044contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013045
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013046When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13047uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13048is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13049answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13050
13051When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013052used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013053
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013054 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13055 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13056 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013057
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013058 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13059 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013060
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013061 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13062 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13063 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013064
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013065For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13066following scenarios are possible:
13067
13068 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13069 ignored
13070
13071 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13072 applied
13073
13074 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13075 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13076
13077 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13078 retries the query with a new type
13079
13080 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13081 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013082
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013083As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13084a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013085<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013086
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013087
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013088resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013089 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013090
13091A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13092
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013093accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013094 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013095 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013096 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13097 by RFC 6891)
13098
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013099 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13100
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013101nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13102 DNS server description:
13103 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13104 <ip> : IP address of the server
13105 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13106
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013107parse-resolv-conf
13108 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13109 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13110 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13111
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013112hold <status> <period>
13113 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13114 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013115 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013116 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013117 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13118 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13119 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13120
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013121 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013122
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013123resolve_retries <nb>
13124 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13125 giving up.
13126 Default value: 3
13127
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013128 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13129 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13130 type.
13131
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013132timeout <event> <time>
13133 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13134 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13135 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013136 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13137 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013138 Default value: 1s
13139 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013140 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013141 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013142 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13143 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13144
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013145 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013146
13147 resolvers mydns
13148 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13149 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013150 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013151 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013152 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013153 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013154 hold other 30s
13155 hold refused 30s
13156 hold nx 30s
13157 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013158 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013159 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013160
13161
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200131626. Cache
13163---------
13164
13165HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13166(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13167RAM.
13168
13169The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13170this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13171
13172If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13173independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13174when we try to allocate a new one.
13175
13176The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13177
13178It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13179"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13180for more details.
13181
13182When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13183replaced by "<CACHE>".
13184
13185
131866.1. Limitation
13187----------------
13188
13189The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13190
13191- If the response is not a 200
13192- If the response contains a Vary header
13193- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13194- If the response is not cacheable
13195
13196- If the request is not a GET
13197- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13198- If the request contains an Authorization header
13199
13200
132016.2. Setup
13202-----------
13203
13204To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13205the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13206
13207
132086.2.1. Cache section
13209---------------------
13210
13211cache <name>
13212 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13213 size of cache is mandatory.
13214
13215total-max-size <megabytes>
13216 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13217 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13218
13219max-object-size <bytes>
13220 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13221 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13222 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13223
13224max-age <seconds>
13225 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13226 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13227 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13228 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13229 default.
13230
13231
132326.2.2. Proxy section
13233---------------------
13234
13235http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13236 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13237 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13238 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13239 after this one.
13240
13241http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13242 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13243 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13244 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13245 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13246
13247
13248Example:
13249
13250 backend bck1
13251 mode http
13252
13253 http-request cache-use foobar
13254 http-response cache-store foobar
13255 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13256
13257 cache foobar
13258 total-max-size 4
13259 max-age 240
13260
13261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13263----------------------------------
13264
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013265HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013266client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13267The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13268these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13269but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13270data called patterns.
13271
13272
132737.1. ACL basics
13274---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013275
13276The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13277content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13278from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13279simple :
13280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013281 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013282 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013283 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13284 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013286The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13287adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013288
13289In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013291 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013292
13293This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13294Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13295and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013296an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13297conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13298as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13299are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013300
13301ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13302'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13303which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13304
13305There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13306performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013308The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13309specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13310this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013311methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13312ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013313
13314Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13315 - boolean
13316 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13317 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13318 - string
13319 - data block
13320
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013321Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13322converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13323would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13324The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13325which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13326
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013327Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13328keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13329fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13330which are summarized in the table below :
13331
13332 +---------------------+-----------------+
13333 | Sample or converter | Default |
13334 | output type | matching method |
13335 +---------------------+-----------------+
13336 | boolean | bool |
13337 +---------------------+-----------------+
13338 | integer | int |
13339 +---------------------+-----------------+
13340 | ip | ip |
13341 +---------------------+-----------------+
13342 | string | str |
13343 +---------------------+-----------------+
13344 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13345 +---------------------+-----------------+
13346
13347Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13348matching method, see below.
13349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013350The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13351 - boolean
13352 - integer or integer range
13353 - IP address / network
13354 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13355 - regular expression
13356 - hex block
13357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013358The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13359
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013360 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13361 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013362 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013363 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013364 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013365 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013366 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013368The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13369read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13370if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13371lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13372will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13373beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13374a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13375lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13376exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13377
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013378The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13379parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13380ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13381a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13382check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13383
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013384The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13385socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13386file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013388Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13389loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13390
13391 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13392
13393In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13394the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13395case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13396as well.
13397
13398The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13399sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13400do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13401methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13402is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013403obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013404followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13405default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13406that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13407string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13408
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013409The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13410By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13411string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13412resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13413server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013414waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013415flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13416function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013418There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13419sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13420be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013421
13422 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13423 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013424 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13425 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13426 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13427 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013428
13429 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13430 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013431 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013432
13433 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013434 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013435
13436 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013437 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013438
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013439 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013440 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13441
13442 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13443 binary or string samples.
13444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013445 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13446 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013448 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13449 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13450 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013452 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13453 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013455 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13456 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013458 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13459 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013461 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13462 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013463 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013465 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13466 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13467 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013468
13469For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13470request, it is possible to do :
13471
13472 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13473
13474In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13475buffer, one would use the following acl :
13476
13477 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13478
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013479On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13480possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13481
13482 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013484All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13485criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13486method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13487to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13488criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13489the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013491If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013492the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13493For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013495 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13496 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13497 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13498 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013499
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013500
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013501The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13502types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13503combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13504brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13505default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013507 +-------------------------------------------------+
13508 | Input sample type |
13509 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013510 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013511 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13512 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13513 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013514 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013515 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013516 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013517 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013518 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013519 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013520 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013521 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013522 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013523 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013524 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013525 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013526 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013527 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013528 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013529 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013530 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013531 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013532 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013533 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013534 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013535 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13536 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13537 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013538
13539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135407.1.1. Matching booleans
13541------------------------
13542
13543In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13544Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13545When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13546that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13547
13548Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13549return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13550"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13551
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135537.1.2. Matching integers
13554------------------------
13555
13556Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13557enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13558to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13559
13560Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13561matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13562lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013563
13564For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13565unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13566representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13567
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013568As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13569two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13570instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13571ranges and operators.
13572
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013573For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013574operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13575Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13576of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013577
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013578Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013579
13580 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13581 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13582 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13583 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13584 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13585
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013586For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013587
13588 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13589
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013590This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13591
13592 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13593
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135957.1.3. Matching strings
13596-----------------------
13597
13598String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13599different forms :
13600
13601 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013602 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013603
13604 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013605 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013606
13607 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13608 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13609
13610 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13611 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13612
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013613 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013614 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13615 matches.
13616
13617 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13618 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13619 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013620
13621String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13622exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13623characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13624string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13625to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013626before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013627
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013628Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13629(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13630Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13631
13632Example:
13633 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13634 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13635
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136377.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13638---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013639
13640Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13641they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13642possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13643passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13644the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013645the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13646match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013647
13648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136497.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13650-------------------------------------
13651
13652It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13653not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13654a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13655to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13656digits may be used upper or lower case.
13657
13658Example :
13659 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13660 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13661
13662
136637.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13664---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013665
13666IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13667netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13668within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013669host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013670difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13671at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13672does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13673parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013674
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013675The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13676abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13677
13678 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13679 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13680 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13681 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13682 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13683 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13684 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13685 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13686
13687Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13688192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13689
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013690IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13691Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13692trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13693IPv6 patterns.
13694
13695HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13696following situations :
13697 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13698 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13699 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13700 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13701 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13702 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13703 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13704 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13705 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13706 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013708
137097.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13710----------------------------------
13711
13712Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13713combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13714
13715 - AND (implicit)
13716 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13717 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013719A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013721 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013723Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13724indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013726For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13727"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13728requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13729is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13730
13731 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013732 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13733 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13734 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013735
13736To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13737and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13738
13739 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13740 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13741 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13742 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13743
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013744 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013745 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13746 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13747 use_backend www if host_www
13748
13749It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13750expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13751be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13752the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13753
13754 The following rule :
13755
13756 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013757 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013758
13759 Can also be written that way :
13760
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013761 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013762
13763It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13764to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13765simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13766sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13767good use is the following :
13768
13769 With named ACLs :
13770
13771 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13772 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13773 monitor fail if site_dead
13774
13775 With anonymous ACLs :
13776
13777 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13778
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013779See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13780keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013781
13782
137837.3. Fetching samples
13784---------------------
13785
13786Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13787against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13788sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13789ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13790of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13791available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13792
13793This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13794Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13795compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13796deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13797
13798The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13799matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13800method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13801indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13802
13803As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13804when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13805mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13806the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13807ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13808
13809Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13810multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13811when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013812incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13813are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013814is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13815all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13816
13817Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13818 - name
13819 - name(arg1)
13820 - name(arg1,arg2)
13821
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013822
138237.3.1. Converters
13824-----------------
13825
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013826Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13827of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13828is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13829was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013830has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013831unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13832
13833These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13834sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13835the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013836support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013837
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013838A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13839support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13840supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13841(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13842bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013844The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013845
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001384651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13847 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13848 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13849 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13850 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13851 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13852
13853 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013854 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13855 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013856 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13857 frontend http-in
13858 bind *:8081
13859 default_backend servers
13860 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13861 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13862
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013863add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013864 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013865 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013866 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13867 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013868 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013869 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13870 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13871 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13872 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013873 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013874 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013875
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013876aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13877 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13878 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13879 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13880 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13881 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13882 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13883
13884 Example:
13885 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13886 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13887
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013888and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013889 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013890 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013891 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13892 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013893 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013894 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13895 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13896 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13897 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013898 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013899 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013900
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013901b64dec
13902 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13903 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13904
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013905base64
13906 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013907 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013908 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13909
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013910bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013911 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013912 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013913 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013914 presence of a flag).
13915
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013916bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13917 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13918 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013919 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013920
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013921concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13922 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13923 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13924 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13925 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13926 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13927 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13928 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13929 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13930 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13931 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010013932 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
13933 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
13934 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
13935 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013936
13937 Example:
13938 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13939 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13940 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010013941 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013942 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13943
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013944cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013945 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13946 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013947
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013948crc32([<avalanche>])
13949 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13950 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13951 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13952 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13953 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13954 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13955 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13956 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13957 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13958 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013959 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13960
13961crc32c([<avalanche>])
13962 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13963 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13964 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13965 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13966 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13967 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13968 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13969 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013970
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013971da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013972 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13973 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13974 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13975 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013976 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013977 configuration language.
13978
13979 Example:
13980 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013981 bind *:8881
13982 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013983 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013984
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013985debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13986 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13987 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13988 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13989 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13990 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13991 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13992 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13993 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13994 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13995 printable sample types.
13996
13997 Example:
13998 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013999
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014000div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014001 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14002 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014003 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014004 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14005 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014006 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014007 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14008 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14009 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14010 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014011 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014012 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014013
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014014djb2([<avalanche>])
14015 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14016 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14017 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14018 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14019 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14020 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14021 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014022 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14023 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014024
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014025even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014026 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014027 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14028
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014029field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14030 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14031 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14032 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14033 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14034 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14035 fields.
14036
14037 Example :
14038 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14039 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14040 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14041 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14042 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014043
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014044hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014045 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014046 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014047 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014048 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014049
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014050hex2i
14051 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014052 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014053
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014054http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014055 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14056 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014057 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14058 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14059 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14060 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14061 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14062 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14063 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14064 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014065
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014066in_table(<table>)
14067 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14068 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14069 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014070 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014071 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14072
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014073ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14074 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014075 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014076 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14077 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14078 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14079 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14080 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014081
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014082json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014083 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014084 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014085 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014086 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14087 of errors:
14088 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14089 bytes, ...)
14090 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14091 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14092
14093 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14094 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14095 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14096 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14097 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14098 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014099 - "ascii" : never fails;
14100 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14101 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014102 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014103 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014104 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14105 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14106
14107 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014108 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014109
14110 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014111 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014112 capture request header user-agent len 150
14113 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014114
14115 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14116 GET / HTTP/1.0
14117 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14118
14119 Output log:
14120 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14121
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014122language(<value>[,<default>])
14123 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14124 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14125 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14126 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14127 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14128 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14129 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14130 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14131 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014132 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014133 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14134 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014135
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014136 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014137
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014138 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14139 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014140
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014141 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14142 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14143 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14144 use_backend spanish if es
14145 use_backend french if fr
14146 use_backend english if en
14147 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014148
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014149length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014150 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14151 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14152 type. The result is of type integer.
14153
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014154lower
14155 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14156 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14157 type. The result is of type string.
14158
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014159ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14160 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14161 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14162 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14163 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14164 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14165 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14166
14167 Example :
14168
14169 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014170 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014171 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14172
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014173map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14174map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14175map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14176 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14177 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14178 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14179 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14180 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14181 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14182 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14183 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014184
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014185 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14186 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14187 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014188
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014189 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014190 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014191
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014192 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14193 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14194 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14195 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014196 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14197 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014198 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14199 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14200 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14201 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14202 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14203 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14204 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14205 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014206 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14207 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14208 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014209 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14210 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14211 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14212 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14213 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014214
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014215 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14216 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14217 the corresponding match text.
14218
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014219 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14220 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14221 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14222 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14223 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014224
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014225 Example :
14226
14227 # this is a comment and is ignored
14228 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14229 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14230 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14231 | | | `---------- value
14232 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14233 | `---------------------------- key
14234 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14235
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014236mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014237 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14238 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014239 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014240 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014241 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014242 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14243 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14244 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14245 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014246 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014247 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014248
14249mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014250 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014251 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14252 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014253 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014254 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014255 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014256 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14257 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14258 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14259 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014260 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014261 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014262
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014263nbsrv
14264 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14265 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14266 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14267 map lookup.
14268
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014269neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014270 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14271 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14272 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14273 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014274
14275not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014276 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014277 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014278 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014279 absence of a flag).
14280
14281odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014282 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014283 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14284
14285or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014286 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014287 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014288 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14289 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014290 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014291 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14292 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14293 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14294 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014295 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014296 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014297
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014298protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14299 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14300 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14301 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14302 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14303 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14304 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14305 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14306 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14307 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14308 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14309 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14310
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014311regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014312 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14313 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14314 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14315 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14316 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14317 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14318 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14319 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14320 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014321 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14322 of characters with other ones.
14323
14324 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14325 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14326 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14327 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14328 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14329 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014330
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014331 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014332
14333 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14334 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14335 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014336 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014337
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014338 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14339 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14340
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014341 # capture groups and backreferences
14342 # both lines do the same.
14343 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14344 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14345
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014346capture-req(<id>)
14347 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14348 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14349
14350 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014351 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14352 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014353
14354capture-res(<id>)
14355 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14356 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14357
14358 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014359 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14360 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014361
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014362sdbm([<avalanche>])
14363 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14364 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14365 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14366 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14367 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14368 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14369 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014370 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14371 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014372
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014373set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014374 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14375 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14376 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014377 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014378 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14379 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014380 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014381 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14382 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014383 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014384 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014385
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014386sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014387 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014388 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14389
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014390sha2([<bits>])
14391 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14392 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14393
14394 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14395 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14396
14397 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14398 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14399
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014400srv_queue
14401 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14402 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14403 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14404 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14405 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14406
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014407strcmp(<var>)
14408 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14409 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14410 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14411 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14412 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14413 shorter).
14414
14415 Example :
14416
14417 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14418 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14419 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14420
14421
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014422sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014423 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14424 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014425 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014426 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14427 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014428 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014429 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14430 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014431 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014432 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14433 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014434 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014435 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014436
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014437table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14438 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14439 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14440 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14441 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14442 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14443 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14444
14445
14446table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14447 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14448 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14449 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14450 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14451 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14452 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14453
14454table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14455 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14456 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014457 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014458 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14459 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14460
14461table_conn_cur(<table>)
14462 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14463 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14464 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14465 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14466 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14467
14468table_conn_rate(<table>)
14469 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14470 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14471 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14472 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14473 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14474
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014475table_gpt0(<table>)
14476 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14477 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14478 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14479 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14480 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14481
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014482table_gpc0(<table>)
14483 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14484 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14485 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14486 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14487 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14488
14489table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14490 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14491 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14492 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14493 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14494 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14495 sample fetch keyword.
14496
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014497table_gpc1(<table>)
14498 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14499 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14500 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14501 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14502 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14503
14504table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14505 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14506 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14507 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14508 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14509 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14510 sample fetch keyword.
14511
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014512table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14513 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14514 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014515 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014516 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14517 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14518
14519table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14520 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14521 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14522 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14523 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14524 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14525 keyword.
14526
14527table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14528 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14529 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014530 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014531 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14532 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14533
14534table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14535 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14536 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14537 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14538 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14539 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14540 keyword.
14541
14542table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14543 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14544 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014545 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014546 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14547 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14548 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14549 keyword.
14550
14551table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14552 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14553 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014554 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014555 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14556 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14557 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14558 keyword.
14559
14560table_server_id(<table>)
14561 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14562 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14563 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14564 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14565 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14566 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14567
14568table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14569 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14570 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014571 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014572 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14573 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14574 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14575 keyword.
14576
14577table_sess_rate(<table>)
14578 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14579 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14580 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14581 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14582 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14583 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14584 keyword.
14585
14586table_trackers(<table>)
14587 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14588 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14589 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14590 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14591 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14592 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14593 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14594 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14595 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14596 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14597
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014598upper
14599 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14600 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14601 type. The result is of type string.
14602
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014603url_dec([<in_form>])
14604 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14605 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14606 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14607 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14608 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14609 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014610
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014611ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014612 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014613 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14614 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14615 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014616 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14617 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14618 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14619 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014620 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014621 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14622 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014623
14624 Example:
14625 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14626 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14627
14628 message Point {
14629 int32 latitude = 1;
14630 int32 longitude = 2;
14631 }
14632
14633 message PPoint {
14634 Point point = 59;
14635 }
14636
14637 message Rectangle {
14638 // One corner of the rectangle.
14639 PPoint lo = 48;
14640 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14641 PPoint hi = 49;
14642 }
14643
14644 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14645 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14646 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14647
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014648 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14649 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014650 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014651 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14652
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014653 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014654
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014655 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014656
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014657 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014658 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14659 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14660
14661 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14662 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14663 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14664
14665 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14666 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14667 interpret the previous binary sample.
14668
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014669
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014670unset-var(<var name>)
14671 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14672 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14673 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14674 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14675 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14676 response),
14677 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14678 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14679 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14680 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14681
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014682utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14683 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14684 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14685 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14686 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14687 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14688 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14689
14690 Example :
14691
14692 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014693 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014694 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14695
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014696word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14697 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14698 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14699 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014700 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014701 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14702 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14703
14704 Example :
14705 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14706 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14707 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14708 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14709 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014710 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014711
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014712wt6([<avalanche>])
14713 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14714 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14715 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14716 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14717 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14718 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14719 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014720 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14721 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014722
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014723xor(<value>)
14724 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014725 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014726 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014727 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014728 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014729 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14730 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014731 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014732 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14733 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014734 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014735 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014736
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014737xxh32([<seed>])
14738 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14739 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14740 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14741 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14742 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14743 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14744 as cryptographically secure.
14745
14746xxh64([<seed>])
14747 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14748 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14749 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14750 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14751 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14752 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14753 as cryptographically secure.
14754
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014755
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147567.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014757--------------------------------------------
14758
14759A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14760not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14761"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14762The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14763
14764always_false : boolean
14765 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14766 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14767
14768always_true : boolean
14769 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14770 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14771
14772avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014773 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014774 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14775 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14776 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14777 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14778 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14779 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14780 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14781 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14782 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14783 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14784 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14785 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14786 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014788be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014789 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14790 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14791 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14792 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014793 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14794
14795be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14796 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14797 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14798 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14799 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14800 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014801 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14802 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014803
14804 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14805 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14806 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014808be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14809 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14810 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14811 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014812 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014813 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14814 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014815
14816 Example :
14817 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14818 backend dynamic
14819 mode http
14820 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14821 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014822
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014823bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014824 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14825 of the string.
14826
14827bool(<bool>) : bool
14828 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14829 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014831connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14832 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014833 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014834 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14835 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014836
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014837 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014838 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014839 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14840
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014841 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14842 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014843
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014844 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014845 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014846 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014847 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014848 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014849 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014850 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014851
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014852 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14853 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014854 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014855 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014856
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014857cpu_calls : integer
14858 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14859 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14860 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14861 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14862 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14863 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14864
14865cpu_ns_avg : integer
14866 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14867 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14868 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14869 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14870 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14871 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14872 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14873 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14874 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14875 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14876 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14877
14878cpu_ns_tot : integer
14879 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14880 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14881 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14882 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14883 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14884 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14885 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14886 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14887 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14888 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14889 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14890 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14891 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14892
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014893date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014894 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014895
14896 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14897 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14898 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014899 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14900
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014901 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14902 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14903 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14904 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14905 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14906
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014907 Example :
14908
14909 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14910 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014911
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014912 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14913 # millisecond granularity
14914 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14915
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014916date_us : integer
14917 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14918 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14919 from the same timeval structure.
14920
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014921distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14922 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14923 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14924 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14925 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14926 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14927 list of supported tokens.
14928
14929distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14930 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14931 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14932 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14933 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14934 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14935 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14936 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14937 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14938 supported tokens.
14939
14940 Example :
14941 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14942 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14943 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14944 # send large files to the big farm
14945 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14946
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014947env(<name>) : string
14948 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14949 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14950 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14951 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14952 certain way.
14953
14954 Examples :
14955 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14956 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14957
14958 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14959 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014961fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14962 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014963 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14964 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014965 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14966 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014967 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014968 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14969 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014970
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014971fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14972 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14973 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14974 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014976fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14977 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14978 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14979 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14980 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14981 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14982 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14983 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14984 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014985
14986 Example :
14987 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14988 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14989 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14990 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14991 frontend mail
14992 bind :25
14993 mode tcp
14994 maxconn 100
14995 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14996 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14997 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14998 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014999
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015000hostname : string
15001 Returns the system hostname.
15002
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015003int(<integer>) : signed integer
15004 Returns a signed integer.
15005
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015006ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15007 Returns an ipv4.
15008
15009ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15010 Returns an ipv6.
15011
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015012lat_ns_avg : integer
15013 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15014 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15015 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15016 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15017 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15018 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15019 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15020 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15021 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15022 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15023 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15024 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15025 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15026 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15027
15028lat_ns_tot : integer
15029 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15030 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15031 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15032 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15033 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15034 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15035 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15036 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15037 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15038 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15039 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15040 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15041 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15042 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15043 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15044 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15045 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15046 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15047 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15048
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015049meth(<method>) : method
15050 Returns a method.
15051
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015052nbproc : integer
15053 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15054 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15055 and debugging purposes.
15056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015057nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15058 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15059 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15060 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015061 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15062 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15063 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015064
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015065prio_class : integer
15066 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15067 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15068 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15069
15070prio_offset : integer
15071 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15072 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15073 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15074 set-priority-offset".
15075
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015076proc : integer
15077 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15078 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15079 debugging purposes.
15080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015081queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015082 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15083 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15084 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015085 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15086 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15087 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15088 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15089 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15090
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015091rand([<range>]) : integer
15092 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15093 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15094 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15095 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15096 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15097
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015098uuid([<version>]) : string
15099 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15100 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15101 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015103srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15104 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15105 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15106 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15107 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15108 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015109 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15110 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15111
15112srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15113 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15114 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15115 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15116 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15117 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15118 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15119 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15120
15121 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15122 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015123
15124srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15125 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15126 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15127 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015128 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015129 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15130 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15131 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15132
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015133srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15134 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15135 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15136 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15137 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15138 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15139 fetch methods.
15140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015141srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15142 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15143 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015144 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015145 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15146 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015147 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015148 overloading servers).
15149
15150 Example :
15151 # Redirect to a separate back
15152 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15153 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15154 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15155
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015156stopping : boolean
15157 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15158 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15159 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15160
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015161str(<string>) : string
15162 Returns a string.
15163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015164table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15165 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15166 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15167
15168table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15169 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15170 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15171 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15172
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015173thread : integer
15174 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15175 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15176 and debugging purposes.
15177
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015178var(<var-name>) : undefined
15179 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015180 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15181 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015182 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015183 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15184 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015185 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015186 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15187 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015188 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015189 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015190
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151917.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015192----------------------------------
15193
15194The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15195closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15196methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15197sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15198TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015199the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15200counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015201"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15202used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15203can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15204Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15205table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15206tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15207currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015208
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015209bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015210 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15211 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15212 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015214be_id : integer
15215 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15216 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15217
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015218be_name : string
15219 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15220 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015222dst : ip
15223 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15224 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15225 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15226 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015227 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15228 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15229 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15230 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15231 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15232 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015233
15234dst_conn : integer
15235 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15236 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15237 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15238 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15239 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15240 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15241 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15242 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015243
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015244dst_is_local : boolean
15245 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15246 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15247 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15248 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015249 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015250 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15251 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15252 it only once per connection.
15253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015254dst_port : integer
15255 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15256 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15257 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15258 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15259 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15260 an HTTP header.
15261
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015262fc_http_major : integer
15263 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15264 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15265 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15266
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015267fc_pp_authority : string
15268 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15269 if any.
15270
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010015271fc_pp_unique_id : string
15272 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15273 if any.
15274
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015275fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15276 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15277 header.
15278
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015279fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15280 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15281 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15282 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15283 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15284 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15285 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15286
15287fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15288 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15289 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15290 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15291 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15292 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15293 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15294
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015295fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015296 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15297 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15298 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15299 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15300
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015301fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015302 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15303 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15304 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15305 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15306
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015307fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015308 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15309 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15310 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15311 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15312
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015313fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015314 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15315 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15316 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15317 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15318
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015319fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015320 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15321 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15322 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15323 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15324
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015325fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015326 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15327 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15328 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15329 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15330
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015331fe_defbe : string
15332 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15333 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015335fe_id : integer
15336 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015337 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015338 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15339
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015340fe_name : string
15341 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15342 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15343 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15344
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015345sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015346sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15347sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15348sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015349 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15350 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15351 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15352
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015353sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015354sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15355sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15356sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015357 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15358 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15359 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15360
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015361sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015362sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15363sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15364sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015365 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15366 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015367 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15368 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15369 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015370
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015371 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015372 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15373 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015374 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15375 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15376 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015377 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15378 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15379
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015380sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15381sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15382sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15383sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15384 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15385 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15386 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15387 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15388 when a first ACL was verified.
15389
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015390sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015391sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15392sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15393sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015394 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015395 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15396
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015397sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015398sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15399sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15400sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015401 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15402 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15403 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15404
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015405sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015406sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15407sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15408sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015409 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15410 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15411 See also src_conn_rate.
15412
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015413sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015414sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15415sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15416sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015417 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015418 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015419
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015420sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15421sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15422sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15423sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15424 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15425 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15426
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015427sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15428sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15429sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15430sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15431 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15432 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15433
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015434sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015435sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15436sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15437sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015438 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15439 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15440 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015441 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15442 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15443 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015444
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015445sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15446sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15447sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15448sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15449 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15450 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15451 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15452 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15453 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15454 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15455
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015456sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015457sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15458sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15459sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015460 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015461 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15462 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15463
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015464sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015465sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15466sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15467sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015468 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15469 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15470 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15471 src_http_err_rate.
15472
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015473sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015474sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15475sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15476sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015477 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015478 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15479 src_http_req_cnt.
15480
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015481sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015482sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15483sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15484sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015485 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15486 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15487 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15488 src_http_req_rate.
15489
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015490sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015491sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15492sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15493sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015494 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015495 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15496 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15497 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15498 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015499
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015500 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015501 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15502 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015503 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15504
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015505sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15506sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15507sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15508sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15509 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15510 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15511 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15512 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15513 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15514
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015515sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015516sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15517sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15518sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015519 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15520 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15521 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015522
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015523sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015524sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15525sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15526sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015527 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15528 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15529 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015530
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015531sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015532sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15533sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15534sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015535 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015536 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15537 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15538 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015539 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015540 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15541
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015542sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015543sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15544sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15545sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015546 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15547 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15548 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15549 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15550 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015551 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015552
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015553sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015554sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15555sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15556sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015557 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15558 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15559 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15560
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015561sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015562sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15563sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15564sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015565 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15566 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015567 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015568 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15569 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015570 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15571 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15572 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015574so_id : integer
15575 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15576 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15577 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015578
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015579so_name : string
15580 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15581 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15582 strings instead of integers.
15583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015584src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015585 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015586 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15587 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15588 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015589 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15590 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15591 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015592 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15593 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15594 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15595 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15596 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15597 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15598 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015599
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015600 Example:
15601 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15602 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15605 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15606 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15607 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015608 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15611 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15612 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015613 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015614 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015616src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15617 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15618 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15619 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15620 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15621 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15622 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015623
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015624 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015625 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15626 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15627 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15628 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015629 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015630 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15631 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15632
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015633src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15634 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15635 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15636 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15637 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15638 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15639 was verified.
15640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015641src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015642 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015644 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015645 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015647src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015648 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15650 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015651 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015653src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15654 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15655 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15656 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015657 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015659src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015660 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015662 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015663 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015664
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015665src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15666 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15667 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15668 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15669 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15670
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015671src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15672 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15673 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15674 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15675 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015678 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015679 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015680 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15681 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015682 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15683 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15684 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015685
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015686src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15687 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15688 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15689 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15690 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15691 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15692 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15693 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015695src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015696 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015697 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015698 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015699 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015700 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15703 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15704 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15705 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15706 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015707 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015710 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015711 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15712 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015713 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15716 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15717 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15718 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015719 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015720 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15723 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15724 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15725 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015726 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015727 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15728 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015729
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015730 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015731 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015732 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015733 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015734
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015735src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15736 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15737 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15738 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15739 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15740 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15741 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15742
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015743src_is_local : boolean
15744 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15745 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15746 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15747 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015748 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015749 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15750 once per connection.
15751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015752src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015753 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15754 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15755 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15756 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15757 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015759src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015760 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15761 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15762 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15763 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15764 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015766src_port : integer
15767 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15768 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15769 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15770 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015772src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015773 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015774 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15775 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15776 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015777 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015779src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15780 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15781 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15782 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15783 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015784 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015786src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15787 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15788 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15789 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15790 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15791 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15792 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15793 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15794 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015795
15796 Example :
15797 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15798 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15799 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15800 listen ssh
15801 bind :22
15802 mode tcp
15803 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015804 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015805 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015806 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015808srv_id : integer
15809 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15810 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15811 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015812
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015813srv_name : string
15814 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15815 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15816 debugging.
15817
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158187.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015819----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015821The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15822closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15823when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15824usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015825future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015826
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001582751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15828 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15829 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15830 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15831 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15832 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15833
15834 Example :
15835 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15836 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15837 # the request.
15838 frontend http-in
15839 bind *:8081
15840 default_backend servers
15841 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15842 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15843
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015844ssl_bc : boolean
15845 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15846 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15847 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15848
15849ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15850 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15851 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15852
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015853ssl_bc_alpn : string
15854 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15855 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015856 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015857 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15858 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15859 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15860 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15861 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15862 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15863
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015864ssl_bc_cipher : string
15865 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15866 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15867
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015868ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15869 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15870 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15871 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15872
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015873ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15874 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15875 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15876 session or a TLS ticket.
15877
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015878ssl_bc_npn : string
15879 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15880 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015881 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015882 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15883 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15884 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15885 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15886 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15887
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015888ssl_bc_protocol : string
15889 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15890 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15891
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015892ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015893 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015894 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15895 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015896
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015897ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15898 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15899 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15900 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15901
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015902ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15903 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15904 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15905 if session was reused or not.
15906
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015907ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15908 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15909 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15910 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15911 BoringSSL.
15912
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015913ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15914 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15915 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015917ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15918 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15919 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15920 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15921 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15922 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015924ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15925 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15926 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15927 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15928 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015929
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015930ssl_c_der : binary
15931 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15932 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15933 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015935ssl_c_err : integer
15936 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15937 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15938 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15939 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15940 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015941
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015942ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015943 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15944 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15945 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15946 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15947 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15948 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15949 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15950 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015951 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15952 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15953 LDAP v3.
15954 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15955 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015957ssl_c_key_alg : string
15958 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15959 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15960 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015962ssl_c_notafter : string
15963 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15964 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15965 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015967ssl_c_notbefore : string
15968 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15969 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15970 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015971
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015972ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015973 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15974 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15975 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15976 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15977 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15978 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15979 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15980 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015981 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15982 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15983 LDAP v3.
15984 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15985 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015987ssl_c_serial : binary
15988 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15989 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15990 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015992ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15993 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15994 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15995 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015996 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15997 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15998
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015999 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016000 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016002ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16003 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16004 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16005 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007ssl_c_used : boolean
16008 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16009 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011ssl_c_verify : integer
16012 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16013 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16014 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16015 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016017ssl_c_version : integer
16018 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16019 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016020
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016021ssl_f_der : binary
16022 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16023 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16024 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16025
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016026ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016027 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16028 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16029 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16030 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016031 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016032 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16033 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16034 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016035 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16036 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16037 LDAP v3.
16038 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16039 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041ssl_f_key_alg : string
16042 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16043 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16044 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016046ssl_f_notafter : string
16047 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16048 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16049 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016051ssl_f_notbefore : string
16052 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16053 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16054 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016055
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016056ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016057 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16058 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16059 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16060 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16061 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16062 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16063 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16064 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016065 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16066 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16067 LDAP v3.
16068 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16069 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016071ssl_f_serial : binary
16072 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16073 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16074 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016075
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016076ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16077 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16078 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16079 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016081ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16082 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16083 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16084 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016086ssl_f_version : integer
16087 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16088 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16089
16090ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016091 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16092 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16093 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016095 Example :
16096 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16097 listen http-https
16098 bind :80
16099 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16100 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16101
16102ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16103 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16104 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16105
16106ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016107 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016108 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16109 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16110 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16111 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16112 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16113 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16114 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16115 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016117ssl_fc_cipher : string
16118 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16119 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016120
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016121ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16122 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16123 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016124 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016125
16126ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16127 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16128 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016129 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016130
16131ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16132 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16133 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16134 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016135 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016136 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016137
16138ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16139 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16140 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016141 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016142
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016143ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16144 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16145 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16146 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016149 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16150 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016151 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16152 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16153 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16154 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016155
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016156ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16157 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16158 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16159 wait until the handshake happened.
16160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016161ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16162 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016163 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16164 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016165 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016166 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016167
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016168ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016169 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016170 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16171 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016173ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016174 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016175 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16176 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16177 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16178 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16179 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16180 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16181 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016183ssl_fc_protocol : string
16184 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16185 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016186
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016187ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016188 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016189 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16190 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016191
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016192ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16193 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16194 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16195 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016197ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16198 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16199 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16200 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16201 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016202
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016203ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16204 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16205 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16206 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16207 BoringSSL.
16208
16209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016210ssl_fc_sni : string
16211 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16212 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16213 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16214 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16215 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16216
16217 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16218 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16219 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016220 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016221 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016223 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016224 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16225 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016227ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16228 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16229 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016230
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016231
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200162327.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016233------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016235Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16236sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16237only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16238For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16239be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16240can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16241sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16242for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16243content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016245payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016246 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016247 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16248 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016250payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16251 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016252 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016253 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016254
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016255req.hdrs : string
16256 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16257 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16258 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16259 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16260
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016261req.hdrs_bin : binary
16262 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16263 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16264 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16265 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16266 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16267 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16268
16269 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16270
16271 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16272 str: <int:length><bytes>
16273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016274req.len : integer
16275req_len : integer (deprecated)
16276 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16277 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16278 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16279 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16280 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16281 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16282 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16283 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016285req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16286 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016287 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16288 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16289 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16290 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016292 ACL alternatives :
16293 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016295req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16296 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16297 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16298 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16299 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016301 ACL alternatives :
16302 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016304 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016306req.proto_http : boolean
16307req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16308 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16309 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16310 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16311 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16312 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16313 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16314 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016316 Example:
16317 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16318 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16319 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016320 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016322req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16323rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16324 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16325 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16326 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16327 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16328 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16329 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16330 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016332 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16333 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16334 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16335 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16336 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16337 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016339 ACL derivatives :
16340 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016342 Example :
16343 listen tse-farm
16344 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16345 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16346 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16347 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16348 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16349 persist rdp-cookie
16350 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16351 # This is only useful makes sense if
16352 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16353 stick-table type string size 204800
16354 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16355 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16356 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016358 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16359 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016361req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16362rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16363 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16364 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16365 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16366 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016368 ACL derivatives :
16369 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016370
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016371req.ssl_alpn : string
16372 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16373 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16374 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16375 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16376 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16377 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016378 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016379
16380 Examples :
16381 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16382 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16383 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016384 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016385 default_backend bk_default
16386
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016387req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16388 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16389 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016390 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16391 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16392 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16393 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16394 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016396req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16397req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16398 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16399 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16400 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16401 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16402 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16403 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16404 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016406req.ssl_sni : string
16407req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16408 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16409 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16410 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16411 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16412 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16413 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16414 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16415 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16416 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16417 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16418 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16419 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016421 ACL derivatives :
16422 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016424 Examples :
16425 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16426 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16427 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16428 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16429 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016430
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016431req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16432 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16433 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16434 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16435 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16436 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16437 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16438 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16439 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16440 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016442req.ssl_ver : integer
16443req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16444 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16445 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16446 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16447 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16448 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16449 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16450 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016451 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016452 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016454 ACL derivatives :
16455 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016456
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016457res.len : integer
16458 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16459 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16460 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16461 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16462 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16463 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16464 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16465 content inspection.
16466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016467res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16468 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016469 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16470 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16471 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16472 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016474res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16475 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16476 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16477 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16478 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016480 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016481
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016482res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16483rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16484 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16485 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16486 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16487 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16488 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16489 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16490 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016492wait_end : boolean
16493 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16494 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016495 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016496 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16497 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016498 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016499 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16500 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016502 Examples :
16503 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16504 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16505 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016507 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16508 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16509 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16510 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16511 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16512 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16513 tcp-request content reject
16514
16515
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200165167.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016517--------------------------------------
16518
16519It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16520This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16521data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16522its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16523HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16524content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16525to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16526more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16527response are indexed.
16528
16529base : string
16530 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16531 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16532 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16533 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16534 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16535 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16536 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16537 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16538
16539 ACL derivatives :
16540 base : exact string match
16541 base_beg : prefix match
16542 base_dir : subdir match
16543 base_dom : domain match
16544 base_end : suffix match
16545 base_len : length match
16546 base_reg : regex match
16547 base_sub : substring match
16548
16549base32 : integer
16550 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16551 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16552 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016553 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16554 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16555 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016556
16557base32+src : binary
16558 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16559 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16560 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16561 per-URL counters.
16562
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016563capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16564 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16565 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16566 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16567
16568capture.req.method : string
16569 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16570 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16571 because it's allocated.
16572
16573capture.req.uri : string
16574 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16575 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16576 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16577 allocated.
16578
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016579capture.req.ver : string
16580 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16581 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16582 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16583
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016584capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16585 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16586 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16587 The first entry is an index of 0.
16588 See also: "capture response header"
16589
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016590capture.res.ver : string
16591 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16592 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16593 persistent flag.
16594
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016595req.body : binary
16596 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16597 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16598 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16599 the first chunk is analyzed.
16600
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016601req.body_param([<name>) : string
16602 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16603 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16604 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16605 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16606 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16607 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16608 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16609 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16610 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16611 given.
16612
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016613req.body_len : integer
16614 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16615 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16616 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16617 "option http-buffer-request".
16618
16619req.body_size : integer
16620 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16621 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16622 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16623 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16624 "option http-buffer-request".
16625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016626req.cook([<name>]) : string
16627cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16628 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16629 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16630 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16631 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16632 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16633 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16634 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16635 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16636
16637 ACL derivatives :
16638 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16639 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16640 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16641 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16642 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16643 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16644 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16645 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016647req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16648cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16649 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16650 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016652req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16653cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16654 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16655 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16656 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16657 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016659cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16660 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16661 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16662 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16663 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016664 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016665 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16666 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16667 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16668 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016670hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16671 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16672 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16673 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16674 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016675 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016677req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16678 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16679 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16680 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16681 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16682 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16683 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16684 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16685 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016687req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16688 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16689 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16690 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16691 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016693req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16694 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16695 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16696 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16697 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16698 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16699 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16700 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16701 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016702 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016703 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016704 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016706 ACL derivatives :
16707 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16708 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16709 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16710 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16711 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16712 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16713 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16714 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16715
16716req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16717hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16718 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16719 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16720 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16721 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16722 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16723 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16724 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16725 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16726 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16727
16728req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16729hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16730 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16731 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16732 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16733 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16734 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016735 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016736 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16737 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16738
16739req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16740hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16741 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16742 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16743 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16744 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16745 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16746 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16747 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16748
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016749
16750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016751http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16752 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16753 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16754 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16755 basic auth is supported.
16756
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016757http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16758 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16759 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16760 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16761 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016762 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16763 basic auth is supported.
16764
16765 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016766 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16767 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16768 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16769 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016770
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016771http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016772 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16773 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16774 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016775
16776http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016777 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16778 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16779 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016780
16781http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016782 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16783 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16784 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016786http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016787 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16788 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016789 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16790 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016792method : integer + string
16793 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16794 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16795 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16796 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16797 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16798 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16799 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016801 ACL derivatives :
16802 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016804 Example :
16805 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16806 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16807 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016809path : string
16810 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16811 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16812 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16813 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16814 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016815 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016816 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016818 ACL derivatives :
16819 path : exact string match
16820 path_beg : prefix match
16821 path_dir : subdir match
16822 path_dom : domain match
16823 path_end : suffix match
16824 path_len : length match
16825 path_reg : regex match
16826 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016827
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016828query : string
16829 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16830 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16831 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16832 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016833 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016834 which stops before the question mark.
16835
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016836req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16837 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16838 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16839 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16840 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016842req.ver : string
16843req_ver : string (deprecated)
16844 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16845 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16846 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016848 ACL derivatives :
16849 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016851res.comp : boolean
16852 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16853 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16854 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016856res.comp_algo : string
16857 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16858 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16859 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016861res.cook([<name>]) : string
16862scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16863 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16864 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16865 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016867 ACL derivatives :
16868 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016870res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16871scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16872 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16873 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16874 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016876res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16877scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16878 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16879 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16880 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016882res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16883 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16884 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16885 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16886 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16887 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16888 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16889 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16890 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16891 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016893res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16894 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16895 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16896 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16897 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16898 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016900res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16901shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16902 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16903 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16904 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16905 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16906 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16907 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16908 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16909 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016911 ACL derivatives :
16912 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16913 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16914 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16915 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16916 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16917 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16918 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16919 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16920
16921res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16922shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16923 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16924 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16925 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16926 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16927 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016929res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16930shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16931 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16932 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16933 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16934 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16935 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16936 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016937
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016938res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16939 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16940 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16941 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16942 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016944res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16945shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16946 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16947 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16948 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16949 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16950 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16951 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016953res.ver : string
16954resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16955 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16956 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016958 ACL derivatives :
16959 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016961set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16962 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16963 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016964 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016965 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016967 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16968 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016970status : integer
16971 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16972 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16973 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016974
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016975unique-id : string
16976 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16977 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16978 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16979 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16980 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16981 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016983url : string
16984 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16985 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16986 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16987 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16988 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16989 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16990 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016992 ACL derivatives :
16993 url : exact string match
16994 url_beg : prefix match
16995 url_dir : subdir match
16996 url_dom : domain match
16997 url_end : suffix match
16998 url_len : length match
16999 url_reg : regex match
17000 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017002url_ip : ip
17003 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17004 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17005 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17006 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17007 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17008 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17009 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017011url_port : integer
17012 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17013 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17014 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17015 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017016
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017017urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17018url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017019 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
17020 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017021 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
17022 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
17023 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
17024 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017025 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
17026 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017027 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
17028 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017030 ACL derivatives :
17031 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
17032 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
17033 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
17034 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
17035 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
17036 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
17037 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
17038 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017039
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017041 Example :
17042 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
17043 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
17044 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
17045 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017046
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017047urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017048 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
17049 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17050 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017051
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017052url32 : integer
17053 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17054 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17055 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17056 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17057 is an unsigned integer.
17058
17059url32+src : binary
17060 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17061 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17062 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17063
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010017064
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100170657.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
17066---------------------------------------
17067
17068This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17069used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17070purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17071There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17072or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17073any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17074for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17075
17076internal.htx.data : integer
17077 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17078 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17079
17080internal.htx.free : integer
17081 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17082 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17083
17084internal.htx.free_data : integer
17085 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17086 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17087
17088internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17089 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17090 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17091 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17092
17093internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17094 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17095 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17096
17097internal.htx.size : integer
17098 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17099 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17100
17101internal.htx.used : integer
17102 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17103 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17104 direction.
17105
17106internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17107 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17108 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17109 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17110 of the special value :
17111 * head : The oldest inserted block
17112 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017113 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017114
17115internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17116 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17117 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17118 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17119 integer or one of the special value :
17120 * head : The oldest inserted block
17121 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017122 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017123
17124internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17125 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17126 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17127 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17128 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17129
17130 * head : The oldest inserted block
17131 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017132 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017133
17134internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17135 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17136 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17137 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17138 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17139
17140 * head : The oldest inserted block
17141 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017142 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017143
17144internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17145 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17146 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17147 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17148 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17149
17150 * head : The oldest inserted block
17151 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017152 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017153
17154internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17155 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17156 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17157 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17158 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17159
17160 * head : The oldest inserted block
17161 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017162 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017163
17164internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17165 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17166 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17167 it returns false.
17168
17169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200171707.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017171---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017173Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17174every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017175order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017177ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17178---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017179FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017180HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017181HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17182HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017183HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17184HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17185HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17186HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17187LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017188METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017189METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017190METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17191METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17192METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17193METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017194METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017195METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017196RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017197REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017198TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017199WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17200---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017201
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172038. Logging
17204----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017205
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017206One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17207provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17208very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17209provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17210state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017211to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017212headers.
17213
17214In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17215about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17216send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17217
17218 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17219 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17220 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17221 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17222 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017223 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017224 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017225
17226The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17227allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17228as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17229while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17230real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17231delay.
17232
17233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172348.1. Log levels
17235---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017236
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017237TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017238source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017239HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17240in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17241track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17242syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17243about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017244
17245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172468.2. Log formats
17247----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017248
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017249HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017250and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17251slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17252options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017253
17254 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17255 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17256 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17257 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17258 extents.
17259
17260 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17261 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17262 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17263 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17264 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17265
17266 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17267 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17268 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17269 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17270 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17271
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017272 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17273 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17274 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17275 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17276
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017277 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17278
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017279Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17280specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17281field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17282servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17283always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17284identifier.
17285
17286Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17287 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17288 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17289 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17290 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17291
17292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172938.2.1. Default log format
17294-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017295
17296This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17297as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17298format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17299
17300 Example :
17301 listen www
17302 mode http
17303 log global
17304 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17305
17306 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17307 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17308 (www/HTTP)
17309
17310 Field Format Extract from the example above
17311 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17312 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17313 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17314 4 'to' to
17315 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17316 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17317
17318Detailed fields description :
17319 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17320 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17321 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17322 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17323 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17324 and processed the connection.
17325 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17326
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017327In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17328"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17329connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17330
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017331It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17332will eventually disappear.
17333
17334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173358.2.2. TCP log format
17336---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017337
17338The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17339is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17340information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17341counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17342emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17343environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17344the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17345sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017346specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17347not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17348fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17349marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017350
17351 Example :
17352 frontend fnt
17353 mode tcp
17354 option tcplog
17355 log global
17356 default_backend bck
17357
17358 backend bck
17359 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17360
17361 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17362 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17363 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17364
17365 Field Format Extract from the example above
17366 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17367 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17368 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17369 4 frontend_name fnt
17370 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17371 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17372 7 bytes_read* 212
17373 8 termination_state --
17374 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17375 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17376
17377Detailed fields description :
17378 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017379 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17380 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17381 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017382 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017383 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017384 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017385
17386 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017387 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17388 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17389 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017390
17391 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17392 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17393 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017394 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17395 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17396 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17397 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017398
17399 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17400 and processed the connection.
17401
17402 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17403 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17404 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17405 applications.
17406
17407 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17408 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17409 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17410 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17411 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17412
17413 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17414 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17415 See "Timers" below for more details.
17416
17417 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17418 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17419 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17420 "Timers" below for more details.
17421
17422 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017423 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017424 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17425 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17426 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17427 details.
17428
17429 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17430 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17431 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17432 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17433 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17434
17435 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17436 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17437 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17438 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17439 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17440 for more details.
17441
17442 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017443 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017444 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17445 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17446 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017447 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017448
17449 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17450 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17451 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17452 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17453 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17454 caused by a denial of service attack.
17455
17456 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17457 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17458 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17459 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17460 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17461 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17462 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17463 denial of service attack.
17464
17465 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17466 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17467 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17468 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17469 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17470 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17471 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17472 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17473 be processed than on other servers.
17474
17475 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17476 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17477 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17478 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17479 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17480 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17481 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17482 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17483 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17484 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17485 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17486 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17487 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17488
17489 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17490 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17491 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17492 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17493 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17494 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017495 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017496 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17497
17498 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17499 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17500 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17501 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17502 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17503 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017504 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017505 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17506 occurs.
17507
17508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175098.2.3. HTTP log format
17510----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017511
17512The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17513is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17514the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17515are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17516emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17517generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17518"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17519which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017520frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17521is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017522
17523Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17524slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17525with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17526
17527 Example :
17528 frontend http-in
17529 mode http
17530 option httplog
17531 log global
17532 default_backend bck
17533
17534 backend static
17535 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17536
17537 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17538 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17539 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017540 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017541
17542 Field Format Extract from the example above
17543 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17544 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017545 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017546 4 frontend_name http-in
17547 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017548 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017549 7 status_code 200
17550 8 bytes_read* 2750
17551 9 captured_request_cookie -
17552 10 captured_response_cookie -
17553 11 termination_state ----
17554 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17555 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17556 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17557 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17558 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017559
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017560Detailed fields description :
17561 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017562 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17563 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17564 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017565 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017566 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017567 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017568
17569 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017570 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17571 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17572 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017573
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017574 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17575 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017576
17577 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17578 and processed the connection.
17579
17580 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17581 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17582 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17583
17584 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17585 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17586 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17587 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17588 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17589 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17590
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017591 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17592 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17593 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017594 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017595 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17596 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017597 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17598 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017599
17600 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17601 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017602 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017603
17604 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17605 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017606 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17607 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017608
17609 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17610 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17611 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17612 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17613 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017614 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17615 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017616
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017617 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17618 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17619 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17620 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17621 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17622 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17623 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017624 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017625
17626 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17627 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17628 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17629
17630 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17631 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017632 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017633 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17634 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17635 overflowing.
17636
17637 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17638 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17639 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17640 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17641 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17642 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17643 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17644 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17645
17646 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17647 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17648 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17649 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17650 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17651 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17652 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17653 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17654
17655 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17656 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17657 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17658 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17659 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17660 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17661 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17662
17663 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017664 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017665 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17666 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17667 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017668 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017669 system.
17670
17671 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17672 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17673 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17674 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17675 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17676 caused by a denial of service attack.
17677
17678 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17679 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17680 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17681 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17682 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17683 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17684 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17685 denial of service attack.
17686
17687 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17688 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17689 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17690 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17691 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17692 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17693 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17694 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17695 processed than on other servers.
17696
17697 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17698 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17699 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17700 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17701 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17702 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17703 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17704 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17705 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17706 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17707 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17708 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17709 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17710
17711 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17712 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17713 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17714 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17715 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17716 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017717 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017718 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17719
17720 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17721 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17722 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17723 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17724 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17725 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017726 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017727 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17728 occurs.
17729
17730 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17731 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17732 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17733 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17734 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17735 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17736 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17737 cookies" below for more details.
17738
17739 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17740 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17741 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17742 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17743 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17744 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17745 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17746 and cookies" below for more details.
17747
17748 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17749 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17750 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17751 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17752 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17753 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17754 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17755 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17756
17757
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200177588.2.4. Custom log format
17759------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017760
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017761The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017762mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017763
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017764HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017765Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17766separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17767prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17768
17769Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17770variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017771("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017772
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017773If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017774as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017775less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17776the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17777
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017778Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017779In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017780in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017781
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017782Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17783'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17784https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17785such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17786
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017787Flags are :
17788 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017789 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017790 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17791 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017792
17793 Example:
17794
17795 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17796 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17797
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017798 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17799
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017800At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17801
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017802 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17803 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017804
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017805the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017806
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017807 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17808 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17809 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017810
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017811and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17812
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017813 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17814 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017815
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017816Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17817
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017818 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017819 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017820 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17821 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17822 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017823 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17824 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17825 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017826 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017827 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17828 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017829 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017830 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17831 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017832 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017833 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017834 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017835 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017836 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017837 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017838 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017839 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17840 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17841 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17842 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17843 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017844 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017845 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17846 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017847 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017848 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17849 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017850 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17851 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17852 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017853 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017854 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17855 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017856 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017857 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17858 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17859 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017860 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017861 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017862 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17863 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17864 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17865 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017866 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017867 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017868 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017869 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017870 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017871 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017872 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17873 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17874 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017875 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017876 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17877 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017878 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017879 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17880 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017881 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017882 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017883 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017884 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017885
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017886 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017887
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017888
178898.2.5. Error log format
17890-----------------------
17891
17892When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17893protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17894By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17895"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017896will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017897logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17898
17899The format looks like this :
17900
17901 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17902 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17903 Connection error during SSL handshake
17904
17905 Field Format Extract from the example above
17906 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17907 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17908 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17909 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17910 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17911
17912These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17913failures.
17914
17915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179168.3. Advanced logging options
17917-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017918
17919Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17920just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17921options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17922for more information about their usage.
17923
17924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179258.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17926------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017927
17928It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17929haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17930commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17931monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17932ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17933
17934 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17935 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17936 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17937 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17938
17939 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17940 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17941 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017942 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017943 such as other load-balancers.
17944
17945 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17946 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17947 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17948
17949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179508.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17951----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017952
17953The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17954what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17955or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017956"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017957just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17958log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17959after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17960is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17961with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17962with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17963
17964
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179658.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17966------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017967
17968Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17969for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17970"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17971retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17972raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17973a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17974file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17975you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17976"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17977
17978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179798.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17980--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017981
17982Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17983multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17984them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17985"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17986logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17987error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17988and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17989too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17990useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17991alternative.
17992
17993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179948.4. Timing events
17995------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017996
17997Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17998reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17999the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18000frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018001mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18002addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18003
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018004Timings events in HTTP mode:
18005
18006 first request 2nd request
18007 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18008 t tr t tr ...
18009 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18010 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18011 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18012 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
18013 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18014
18015Timings events in TCP mode:
18016
18017 TCP session
18018 |<----------------->|
18019 t t
18020 ---|----|----|----|----|---
18021 | Th Tw Tc Td |
18022 |<------ Tt ------->|
18023
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018024 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018025 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018026 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
18027 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
18028 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018029 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018030 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
18031 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
18032 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
18033 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018034
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018035 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
18036 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
18037 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018038 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
18039 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
18040 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
18041 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
18042 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
18043 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018044
18045 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
18046 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
18047 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
18048 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
18049 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
18050 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
18051 request typed by hand during a test.
18052
18053 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18054 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018055 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018056 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18057 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18058 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18059 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018060
18061 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18062 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18063 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18064 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18065 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18066
18067 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18068 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18069 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18070 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18071 connection never established.
18072
18073 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18074 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18075 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18076 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18077 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18078 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18079 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18080 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18081 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18082 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18083 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18084
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018085 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18086 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18087 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18088 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18089 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18090 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18091
18092 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18093
18094 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18095 "Ta" can never be negative.
18096
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018097 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18098 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018099 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18100 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018101 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018102
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018103 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018104
18105 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018106 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18107 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018108
18109These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18110protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18111that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018112due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18113"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18114that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018115
18116Most common cases :
18117
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018118 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18119 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18120 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18121 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18122 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18123 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18124 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18125 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18126 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18127 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18128 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018129 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018130
18131 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18132 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18133 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18134 of ms on remote networks.
18135
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018136 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18137 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18138 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018139
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018140 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18141 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18142 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18143 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18144 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18145 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18146 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18147 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18148 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018149
18150Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18151
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018152 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018153 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018154 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018155
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018156 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018157 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18158 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18159
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018160 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018161 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18162 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18163 flags.
18164
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018165 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18166 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018167 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18168 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18169 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18170 the client connection was maintained open.
18171
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018172 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018173 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018174 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018175 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18176
18177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181788.5. Session state at disconnection
18179-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018180
18181TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18182"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
181832-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18184each of which has a special meaning :
18185
18186 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18187 session to terminate :
18188
18189 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18190
18191 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18192 server explicitly refused it.
18193
18194 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18195 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18196 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18197 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018198 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018199
18200 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18201 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018202
18203 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18204 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18205 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18206 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18207 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18208
18209 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18210 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18211 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18212 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18213 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18214
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018215 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18216 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18217
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018218 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18219 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18220 backup connections when going up.
18221
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018222 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18223
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018224 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18225 send or receive data.
18226
18227 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18228 send or receive data.
18229
18230 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18231 with nothing left in the buffers.
18232
18233 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18234
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018235 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018236 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18237
18238 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18239 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18240 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18241 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18242 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18243
18244 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18245 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18246
18247 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18248 server (HTTP only).
18249
18250 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18251
18252 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18253 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18254 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18255
18256 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18257 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18258 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18259
18260 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18261
18262 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18263 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18264
18265 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18266 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18267 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18268
18269 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18270 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018271 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18272 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018273
18274 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18275 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18276 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18277 another server.
18278
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018279 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018280 server.
18281
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018282 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18283 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18284 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18285 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18286
18287 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18288 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18289 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18290 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18291
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018292 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18293 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18294 "use-server" rule).
18295
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018296 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18297
18298 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18299 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18300
18301 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18302
18303 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18304 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18305 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18306
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018307 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18308 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018309 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018310 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18311 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18312
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018313 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18314
18315 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18316 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18317
18318 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18319
18320 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18321
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018322The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18323was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018324helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18325starvation, attacks, etc...
18326
18327The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18328alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18329easier finding and understanding.
18330
18331 Flags Reason
18332
18333 -- Normal termination.
18334
18335 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18336 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18337 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18338 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18339
18340 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18341 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18342 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18343 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18344 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18345 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018346
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018347 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18348 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018349 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018350
18351 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18352 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18353 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18354
18355 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18356 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18357 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18358 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18359 the server takes too long to respond.
18360
18361 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18362 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18363 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18364 long a time to respond.
18365
18366 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18367 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18368 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18369 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018370 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18371 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018372
18373 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18374 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18375 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18376 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18377 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018378 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018379 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18380 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18381 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18382 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18383 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18384 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18385 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18386 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018387 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018388 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18389 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18390 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018391
18392 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18393 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018394 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18395 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18396 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18397 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018398
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018399 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18400 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018402 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018403 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18404 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018405 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018406 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18407 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18408
18409 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18410 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18411 503 or 504 here.
18412
18413 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18414 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18415 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18416 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18417 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18418
18419 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18420 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018421 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018422 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18423 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18424
18425 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18426 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18427 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18428 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18429 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18430 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18431 between haproxy and the server.
18432
18433 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18434 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18435 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18436 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18437 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18438 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18439 solution is to fix the application.
18440
18441 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18442 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18443 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18444 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18445 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18446 external attacks.
18447
18448 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18449 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018450 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018451 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18452 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18453
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018454 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18455 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18456 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018457 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018458 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018459
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018460 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18461 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18462 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18463 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018464 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18465 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18466 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18467 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18468 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018469
18470 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18471 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18472 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18473 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18474
18475 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18476 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18477 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18478 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18479
18480 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18481 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18482 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18483 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18484
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018485The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18486persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18487important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18488re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18489
18490 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18491
18492 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18493 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18494 set on a GET request.
18495
18496 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18497 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018498 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018499 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18500
18501 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18502 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18503 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18504
18505 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18506 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18507 already got a cookie.
18508
18509 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18510 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18511 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18512 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18513 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18514
18515 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18516 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18517 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18518
18519 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18520 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18521 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18522
18523 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18524 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18525
18526 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18527 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18528 then advertised in the response.
18529
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185318.6. Non-printable characters
18532-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018533
18534In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18535consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18536converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18537prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18538being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18539escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18540is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18541'}' when logging headers.
18542
18543Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18544issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18545containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18546
18547Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18548the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18549performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18550
18551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185528.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18553---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018554
18555Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18556achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018557section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018558cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18559the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18560the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018561locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018562not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18563user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18564a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18565wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18566
18567 Examples :
18568 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18569 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18570
18571 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18572 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18573
18574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185758.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18576---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018577
18578Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18579proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18580the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18581server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18582
18583Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18584response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018585section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018586
18587It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018588time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18589appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018590are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18591and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18592follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18593request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18594in the logs.
18595
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018596As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18597frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18598an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18599
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018600 Example :
18601 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18602 listen proxy-out
18603 mode http
18604 option httplog
18605 option logasap
18606 log global
18607 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18608
18609 # log the name of the virtual server
18610 capture request header Host len 20
18611
18612 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18613 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18614
18615 # log the beginning of the referrer
18616 capture request header Referer len 20
18617
18618 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18619 capture response header Server len 20
18620
18621 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18622 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18623
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018624 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018625 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18626
18627 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18628 capture response header Via len 20
18629
18630 # log the URL location during a redirection
18631 capture response header Location len 20
18632
18633 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18634 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18635 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18636 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18637 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18638
18639 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18640 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18641 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18642 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018643 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018644
18645 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18646 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18647 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18648 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18649 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018650 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018651
18652
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186538.9. Examples of logs
18654---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018655
18656These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18657them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18658reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18659
18660 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18661 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18662 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18663
18664 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18665 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18666
18667 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18668 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18669 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18670
18671 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18672 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18673
18674 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18675 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18676 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18677
18678 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018679 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018680 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18681 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18682
18683 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18684 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18685 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18686
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018687 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18688 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18689 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18690 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18691 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18692 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018693
18694 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018695 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018696
18697 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18698 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18699 Nothing was sent to any server.
18700
18701 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18702 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18703
18704 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18705 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018706 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018707 send a 408 return code to the client.
18708
18709 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18710 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18711
18712 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18713 5 seconds ("c----").
18714
18715 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18716 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018717 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018718
18719 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018720 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018721 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18722 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18723 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18724 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18725 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018726
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018727
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200187289. Supported filters
18729--------------------
18730
18731Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18732accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18733unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18734
18735See also : "filter"
18736
187379.1. Trace
18738----------
18739
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018740filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018741
18742 Arguments:
18743 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18744 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18745
18746 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18747 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18748 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18749 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018751 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018752 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18753 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18754 amount of the parsed data.
18755
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018756 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018757
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018758This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18759callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18760information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18761filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18762
18763Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18764tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18765a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18766
18767
187689.2. HTTP compression
18769---------------------
18770
18771filter compression
18772
18773The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18774keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018775when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18776fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18777done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18778explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18779filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18780listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18781order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018782
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018783See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18784 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018785
18786
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200187879.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18788--------------------------------------------
18789
18790filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18791
18792 Arguments :
18793
18794 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18795 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18796 parsed.
18797
18798 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18799 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18800 part must be placed in its own scope.
18801
18802The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18803external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018804streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018805exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18806also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18807
18808SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18809the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18810
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018811For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018812"doc/SPOE.txt".
18813
18814Important note:
18815 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18816 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18817
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100188189.4. Cache
18819----------
18820
18821filter cache <name>
18822
18823 Arguments :
18824
18825 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18826
18827The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18828"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018829cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018830other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18831case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18832is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18833filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018834listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18835order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018836
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018837See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18838 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18839
18840
188419.5. Fcgi-app
18842-------------
18843
18844filter fcg-app <name>
18845
18846 Arguments :
18847
18848 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18849
18850The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18851request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18852reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18853used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18854implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18855used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18856fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18857used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18858order.
18859
18860See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18861 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18862
18863
1886410. FastCGI applications
18865-------------------------
18866
18867HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18868feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18869the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18870FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18871servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18872FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18873backend.
18874
18875HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18876application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18877connection.
18878
1887910.1. Setup
18880-----------
18881
1888210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18883--------------------------
18884
18885fcgi-app <name>
18886 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18887 document root must be defined.
18888
18889acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18890 Declare or complete an access list.
18891
18892 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18893 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18894 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18895 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18896 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18897
18898docroot <path>
18899 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18900 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18901 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18902
18903index <script-name>
18904 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18905 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18906 is an optional setting.
18907
18908 Example :
18909 index index.php
18910
18911log-stderr global
18912log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18913 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18914 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18915
18916 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18917 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18918
18919pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18920 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18921 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18922 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18923
18924 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18925 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18926 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18927 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18928
18929 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18930 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18931
18932path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018933 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010018934 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
18935 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
18936 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
18937 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
18938 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18939 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
18940 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018941
18942 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018943 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010018944 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
18945 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
18946 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
18947 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018948
18949 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010018950 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
18951 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018952
18953option get-values
18954no option get-values
18955 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18956
18957 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18958 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18959
18960 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18961 application will accept.
18962
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018963 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18964 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018965
18966 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18967 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18968 option is disabled.
18969
18970 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18971 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18972 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18973 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18974 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18975 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18976
18977option keep-conn
18978no option keep-conn
18979 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18980 sending a response.
18981
18982 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18983 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18984
18985option max-reqs <reqs>
18986 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18987 accept.
18988
18989 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18990 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18991 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18992 to 1.
18993
18994option mpxs-conns
18995no option mpxs-conns
18996 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18997
18998 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18999 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19000
19001set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19002 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19003 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19004 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19005 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19006
19007 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19008 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19009 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19010
19011 Example :
19012 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
19013 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
19014
19015 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
19016
19017
1901810.1.2. Proxy section
19019---------------------
19020
19021use-fcgi-app <name>
19022 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
19023
19024 Arguments :
19025 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
19026
19027 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
19028 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
19029 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
19030 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
19031 application may be defined at a time per backend.
19032
19033 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
19034 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
19035 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
19036 application are evaluated.
19037
19038
1903910.1.3. Example
19040---------------
19041
19042 frontend front-http
19043 mode http
19044 bind *:80
19045 bind *:
19046
19047 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
19048 default_backend back-static
19049
19050 backend back-static
19051 mode http
19052 server www A.B.C.D:80
19053
19054 backend back-dynamic
19055 mode http
19056 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19057 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19058
19059 fcgi-app php-fpm
19060 log-stderr global
19061 option keep-conn
19062
19063 docroot /var/www/my-app
19064 index index.php
19065 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19066
19067
1906810.2. Default parameters
19069------------------------
19070
19071A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19072the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019073script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019074applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19075
19076 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19077 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19078 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19079 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19080 | | |
19081 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19082 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19083 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19084 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19085 | | application. |
19086 | | |
19087 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19088 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19089 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19090 | | |
19091 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19092 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19093 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19094 | | the application's configuration. |
19095 | | |
19096 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19097 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19098 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19099 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19100 | | |
19101 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19102 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19103 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19104 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19105 | | be defined. |
19106 | | |
19107 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19108 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19109 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19110 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19111 | | is not set too. |
19112 | | |
19113 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19114 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19115 | | set. |
19116 | | |
19117 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19118 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19119 | | the request. |
19120 | | |
19121 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19122 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19123 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19124 | | |
19125 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19126 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19127 | | script to process the request. |
19128 | | |
19129 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19130 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19131 | | |
19132 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19133 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19134 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19135 | | |
19136 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19137 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19138 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19139 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19140 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19141 | | |
19142 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19143 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19144 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19145 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19146 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19147 | | side. |
19148 | | |
19149 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19150 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19151 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19152 | | connected to. |
19153 | | |
19154 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19155 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19156 | | |
19157 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19158 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19159 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19160 | | |
19161 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19162
19163
1916410.3. Limitations
19165------------------
19166
19167The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19168way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19169during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19170establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19171application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19172or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19173message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19174these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19175and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19176
19177Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19178request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19179requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19180
19181About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19182into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19183fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19184"http-request" ones.
19185
19186Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19187FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19188processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19189must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19190here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019191
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019192/*
19193 * Local variables:
19194 * fill-column: 79
19195 * End:
19196 */